4 @setfilename ../../info/org
5 @settitle The Org Manual
10 @c Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
11 @c Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
12 @set txicodequoteundirected
13 @set txicodequotebacktick
15 @c Version and Contact Info
16 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
17 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
18 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
19 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
20 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
25 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
27 @c Macro definitions for commands and keys
28 @c =======================================
30 @c The behavior of the key/command macros will depend on the flag cmdnames
31 @c When set, commands names are shown. When clear, they are not shown.
35 @c Below we define the following macros for Org key tables:
37 @c orgkey{key} A key item
38 @c orgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name
39 @c xorgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name as @itemx
40 @c orgcmdnki{key,cmd} Like orgcmd, but do not index the key
41 @c orgcmdtkc{text,key,cmd} Like orgcmd,special text instead of key
42 @c orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, use "or"
43 @c orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, but
44 @c different functions, so format as @itemx
45 @c orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as orgcmdkkc, but use "or short"
46 @c xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as previous, but use @itemx
47 @c orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,cmd1,cmd2} Two keys and two commands
49 @c a key but no command
61 @c one key with a command
62 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
63 @macro orgcmd{key,command}
68 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
71 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
80 @c One key with one command, formatted using @itemx
81 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY COMMAND
82 @macro xorgcmd{key,command}
87 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
90 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
99 @c one key with a command, bit do not index the key
100 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
101 @macro orgcmdnki{key,command}
105 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
108 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
116 @c one key with a command, and special text to replace key in item
117 @c Inserts: @item TEXT COMMAND
118 @macro orgcmdtkc{text,key,command}
123 @item @kbd{\text\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
126 @item @kbd{\text\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
135 @c two keys with one command
136 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or KEY2 COMMAND
137 @macro orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,command}
143 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
146 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
152 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\}
156 @c Two keys with one command name, but different functions, so format as
158 @c Inserts: @item KEY1
159 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND
160 @macro orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,command}
167 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
171 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
182 @c Same as previous, but use "or short"
183 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
184 @macro orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
190 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
193 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
199 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
203 @c Same as previous, but use @itemx
204 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
205 @macro xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
211 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
214 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
220 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
224 @c two keys with two commands
225 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 COMMAND1
226 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND2
227 @macro orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,command1,command2}
234 @item @kbd{\key1\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command1\}
235 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command2\}
238 @item @kbd{\key1\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command1\})
239 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command2\})
249 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
252 @c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
255 @c Subheadings inside a table.
256 @macro tsubheading{text}
258 @subsubheading \text\
266 This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
268 Copyright @copyright{} 2004-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
271 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
272 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
273 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
274 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
275 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
276 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
278 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
279 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
280 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
282 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
283 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
284 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
285 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
291 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
295 @title The Org Manual
297 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
298 @author by Carsten Dominik
299 with contributions by David O'Toole, Bastien Guerry, Philip Rooke, Dan Davison, Eric Schulte, Thomas Dye and Jambunathan K.
301 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
303 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
307 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
311 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
318 * Introduction:: Getting started
319 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
320 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
321 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
322 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
323 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
324 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
325 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
326 * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
327 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
328 * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
329 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
330 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
331 * Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
332 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
333 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
334 * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
335 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
336 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
337 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
338 * Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions
339 * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
342 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
346 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
347 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
348 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
349 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
350 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
354 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
355 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
356 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
357 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
358 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
359 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
360 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
361 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
362 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
363 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
364 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
368 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
369 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
370 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
371 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
372 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
373 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
377 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
378 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
379 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
380 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
381 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
382 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
383 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
384 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
385 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
389 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
390 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
391 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
392 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
393 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
394 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
395 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
396 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
400 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
404 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
405 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
406 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
407 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
408 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
409 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
411 Extended use of TODO keywords
413 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
414 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
415 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
416 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
417 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
418 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
419 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
423 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
424 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
425 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
429 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
430 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
431 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
433 Properties and columns
435 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
436 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
437 * Property searches:: Matching property values
438 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
439 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
440 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
444 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
445 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
446 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
450 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
451 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
455 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
456 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
457 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
458 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
459 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
460 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
461 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
465 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
466 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
468 Deadlines and scheduling
470 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
471 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
475 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
476 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
477 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
479 Capture - Refile - Archive
481 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
482 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
483 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
484 * Protocols:: External (e.g.@: Browser) access to Emacs and Org
485 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
486 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
490 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
491 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
492 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
496 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
497 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
501 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
502 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
506 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
507 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
508 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
509 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
510 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
511 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
512 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
513 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
515 The built-in agenda views
517 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
518 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
519 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
520 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
521 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
522 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
524 Presentation and sorting
526 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
527 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
528 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
532 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
533 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
534 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
536 Markup for rich export
538 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
539 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
540 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
541 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
542 * Index entries:: Making an index
543 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
544 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
546 Structural markup elements
548 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
549 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
550 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
551 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
553 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
554 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
555 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
556 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
557 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
561 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
562 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
563 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
564 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
565 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
569 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
570 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
571 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
572 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
573 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
574 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
575 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
576 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
577 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
578 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
579 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
580 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
584 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
585 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
586 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
587 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
588 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
589 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
590 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
591 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
592 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
593 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
595 @LaTeX{} and PDF export
597 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
598 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
599 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
600 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
601 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
602 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
606 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
607 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
608 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
609 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
610 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
611 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
613 OpenDocument Text export
615 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
616 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
617 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
618 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
619 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
620 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
621 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
622 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
623 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
624 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
625 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
627 Math formatting in ODT export
629 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
630 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
632 Advanced topics in ODT export
634 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
635 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
636 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
637 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
638 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
642 * Configuration:: Defining projects
643 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
644 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
645 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
649 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
650 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
651 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
652 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
653 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
654 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
655 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
656 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
660 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
661 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
663 Working with source code
665 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
666 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
667 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
668 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
669 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
670 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
671 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
672 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
673 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
674 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
675 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
676 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
680 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
681 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
683 Using header arguments
685 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
686 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
687 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
688 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
689 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
690 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
692 Specific header arguments
694 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
695 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
696 be collected and handled
697 * file:: Specify a path for file output
698 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
699 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
700 directory for code block execution
701 * exports:: Export code and/or results
702 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
703 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
704 files during tangling
705 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
707 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
709 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
710 expansion during tangling
711 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
712 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
713 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
714 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
715 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
716 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
717 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
718 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
719 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
720 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
721 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
722 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
726 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
727 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
728 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
729 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
730 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
731 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
732 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
733 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
734 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
735 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
736 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
738 Interaction with other packages
740 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
741 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
745 * Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
746 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
747 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
748 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
749 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
750 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
751 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
752 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
753 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
754 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
756 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
758 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
759 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
760 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
761 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
765 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
766 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
767 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
772 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
773 @chapter Introduction
777 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
778 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
779 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
780 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
781 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
784 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
788 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
789 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
791 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
792 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
793 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
794 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
795 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
796 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
797 timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
798 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
799 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
800 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
801 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
802 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
803 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
806 As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to outline
807 nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and
808 create dynamic @i{agenda views}.
810 Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows you to work with
811 embedded source code blocks in a file, to facilitate code evaluation,
812 documentation, and literate programming techniques.
814 Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
815 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
816 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
817 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in @LaTeX{}. The structure
818 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
819 the minor Orgstruct mode.
821 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
822 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
823 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
824 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for different
828 @r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
829 @r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
830 @r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
831 @r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
832 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
833 @r{@bullet{} an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system}
834 @r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and @LaTeX{} export}
835 @r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
836 @r{@bullet{} an environment for literate programming}
841 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
842 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
843 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc@. This page is located at
844 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
846 @cindex print edition
847 The version 7.3 of this manual is available as a
848 @uref{http://www.network-theory.co.uk/org/manual/, paperback book from Network
854 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
855 @section Installation
859 @b{Important:} @i{If you are using a version of Org that is part of the Emacs
860 distribution or an XEmacs package, please skip this section and go directly
861 to @ref{Activation}. To see what version of Org (if any) is part of your
862 Emacs distribution, type @kbd{M-x load-library RET org} and then @kbd{M-x
865 If you have downloaded Org from the Web, either as a distribution @file{.zip}
866 or @file{.tar} file, or as a Git archive, you must take the following steps
867 to install it: go into the unpacked Org distribution directory and edit the
868 top section of the file @file{Makefile}. You must set the name of the Emacs
869 binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths to the
870 directories where local Lisp and Info files are kept. If you don't have
871 access to the system-wide directories, you can simply run Org directly from
872 the distribution directory by adding the @file{lisp} subdirectory to the
873 Emacs load path. To do this, add the following line to @file{.emacs}:
876 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp" load-path))
880 If you plan to use code from the @file{contrib} subdirectory, do a similar
881 step for this directory:
884 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" load-path))
887 @noindent Now byte-compile the Lisp files with the shell command:
893 @noindent If you are running Org from the distribution directory, this is
894 all. If you want to install Org into the system directories, use (as
901 Installing Info files is system dependent, because of differences in the
902 @file{install-info} program. The following should correctly install the Info
903 files on most systems, please send a bug report if not@footnote{The output
904 from install-info (if any) is also system dependent. In particular Debian
905 and its derivatives use two different versions of install-info and you may
909 This is not dpkg install-info anymore, but GNU install-info
910 See the man page for ginstall-info for command line arguments
913 @noindent which can be safely ignored.}.
919 Then add the following line to @file{.emacs}. It is needed so that
920 Emacs can autoload functions that are located in files not immediately loaded
921 when Org mode starts.
923 (require 'org-install)
926 Do not forget to activate Org as described in the following section.
929 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
933 @cindex global key bindings
934 @cindex key bindings, global
936 To make sure files with extension @file{.org} use Org mode, add the following
937 line to your @file{.emacs} file.
939 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
941 @noindent Org mode buffers need font-lock to be turned on - this is the
942 default in Emacs@footnote{If you don't use font-lock globally, turn it on in
943 Org buffer with @code{(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock)}}.
945 The four Org commands @command{org-store-link}, @command{org-capture},
946 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb} should be accessible through
947 global keys (i.e.@: anywhere in Emacs, not just in Org buffers). Here are
948 suggested bindings for these keys, please modify the keys to your own
951 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
952 (global-set-key "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
953 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
954 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
957 @cindex Org mode, turning on
958 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
959 into Org mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
963 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
966 @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
967 @noindent which will select Org mode for this buffer no matter what
968 the file's name is. See also the variable
969 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
971 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
972 use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
973 (@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
974 in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
976 (transient-mark-mode 1)
978 @noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
979 active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
980 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
982 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
989 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
990 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
991 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
992 list after a moderator has approved it@footnote{Please consider subscribing
993 to the mailing list, in order to minimize the work the mailing list
994 moderators have to do.}.
996 For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest
997 version of Org available---if you are running an outdated version, it is
998 quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug persists,
999 prepare a report and provide as much information as possible, including the
1000 version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
1001 (@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
1002 @file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
1004 @kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
1006 @noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
1007 that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
1008 from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
1010 Sometimes you might face a problem due to an error in your Emacs or Org mode
1011 setup. Before reporting a bug, it is very helpful to start Emacs with minimal
1012 customizations and reproduce the problem. Doing so often helps you determine
1013 if the problem is with your customization or with Org mode itself. You can
1014 start a typical minimal session with a command like the example below.
1017 $ emacs -Q -l /path/to/minimal-org.el
1020 However if you are using Org mode as distributed with Emacs, a minimal setup
1021 is not necessary. In that case it is sufficient to start Emacs as @code{emacs
1022 -Q}. The @code{minimal-org.el} setup file can have contents as shown below.
1025 ;;; Minimal setup to load latest `org-mode'
1027 ;; activate debugging
1028 (setq debug-on-error t
1032 ;; add latest org-mode to load path
1033 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/lisp"))
1034 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/contrib/lisp"))
1037 (require 'org-install)
1040 If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
1041 create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
1045 @item What exactly did you do?
1046 @item What did you expect to happen?
1047 @item What happened instead?
1049 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this program.
1051 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
1053 @cindex backtrace of an error
1054 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
1055 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
1056 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
1057 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
1058 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
1062 Reload uncompiled versions of all Org mode Lisp files. The backtrace
1063 contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
1066 C-u M-x org-reload RET
1069 or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
1072 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
1073 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
1075 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
1076 document the steps you take.
1078 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
1079 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
1080 attach it to your bug report.
1083 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
1084 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
1086 Org uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags and property
1087 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
1092 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
1096 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
1097 meaning are written with all capitals.
1100 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
1101 special meaning are written with all capitals.
1104 Moreover, Org uses @i{option keywords} (like @code{#+TITLE} to set the title)
1105 and @i{environment keywords} (like @code{#+BEGIN_HTML} to start a @code{HTML}
1106 environment). They are written in uppercase in the manual to enhance its
1107 readability, but you can use lowercase in your Org files@footnote{Easy
1108 templates insert lowercase keywords and Babel dynamically inserts
1111 The manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for accessing a
1112 functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for different functions,
1113 depending on context. The command that is bound to such keys has a generic
1114 name, like @code{org-metaright}. In the manual we will, wherever possible,
1115 give the function that is internally called by the generic command. For
1116 example, in the chapter on document structure, @kbd{M-@key{right}} will be
1117 listed to call @code{org-do-demote}, while in the chapter on tables, it will
1118 be listed to call org-table-move-column-right.
1120 If you prefer, you can compile the manual without the command names by
1121 unsetting the flag @code{cmdnames} in @file{org.texi}.
1123 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
1124 @chapter Document structure
1125 @cindex document structure
1126 @cindex structure of document
1128 Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
1129 edit the structure of the document.
1132 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
1133 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
1134 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
1135 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
1136 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
1137 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
1138 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
1139 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
1140 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
1141 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
1142 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
1145 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
1148 @cindex Outline mode
1150 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
1151 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
1152 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
1153 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
1154 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
1155 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
1156 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
1157 command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
1159 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
1162 @cindex outline tree
1163 @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
1164 @vindex org-special-ctrl-k
1165 @vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
1167 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
1168 start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
1169 @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
1170 @code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
1171 @kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.} @footnote{Clocking only works with
1172 headings indented less then 30 stars.}. For example:
1175 * Top level headline
1182 * Another top level headline
1185 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
1186 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
1187 starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
1189 @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
1190 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
1191 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
1192 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
1193 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
1194 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
1196 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
1197 @section Visibility cycling
1198 @cindex cycling, visibility
1199 @cindex visibility cycling
1200 @cindex trees, visibility
1201 @cindex show hidden text
1204 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
1205 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
1206 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
1208 @cindex subtree visibility states
1209 @cindex subtree cycling
1210 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
1211 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
1212 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
1214 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1215 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
1218 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
1219 '-----------------------------------'
1222 @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
1223 @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
1224 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
1225 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
1226 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
1227 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
1228 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
1229 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
1231 @cindex global visibility states
1232 @cindex global cycling
1233 @cindex overview, global visibility state
1234 @cindex contents, global visibility state
1235 @cindex show all, global visibility state
1236 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-global-cycle}
1237 @itemx C-u @key{TAB}
1238 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
1241 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
1242 '--------------------------------------'
1245 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
1246 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
1247 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
1249 @cindex show all, command
1250 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB},show-all}
1251 Show all, including drawers.
1252 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-reveal}
1253 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
1254 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
1255 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
1256 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
1257 level, all sibling headings. With a double prefix argument, also show the
1258 entire subtree of the parent.
1259 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,show-branches}
1260 Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
1261 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
1262 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
1265 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
1268 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
1270 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
1271 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
1272 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
1273 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
1274 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
1275 the previously used indirect buffer.
1276 @orgcmd{C-c C-x v,org-copy-visible}
1277 Copy the @i{visible} text in the region into the kill ring.
1280 @vindex org-startup-folded
1281 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
1282 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
1283 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
1284 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
1286 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
1287 OVERVIEW, i.e.@: only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
1288 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
1289 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
1296 #+STARTUP: showeverything
1299 @cindex property, VISIBILITY
1301 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
1302 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
1303 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
1306 @orgcmd{C-u C-u @key{TAB},org-set-startup-visibility}
1307 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e.@: whatever is
1308 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
1312 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
1314 @cindex motion, between headlines
1315 @cindex jumping, to headlines
1316 @cindex headline navigation
1317 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
1320 @orgcmd{C-c C-n,outline-next-visible-heading}
1322 @orgcmd{C-c C-p,outline-previous-visible-heading}
1324 @orgcmd{C-c C-f,org-forward-same-level}
1325 Next heading same level.
1326 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-backward-same-level}
1327 Previous heading same level.
1328 @orgcmd{C-c C-u,outline-up-heading}
1329 Backward to higher level heading.
1330 @orgcmd{C-c C-j,org-goto}
1331 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
1332 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
1333 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
1334 @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
1336 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
1337 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1338 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
1339 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
1340 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
1341 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1342 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
1344 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
1347 @vindex org-goto-interface
1349 See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
1352 @node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
1353 @section Structure editing
1354 @cindex structure editing
1355 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
1356 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
1357 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
1358 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
1359 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
1360 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
1361 @cindex copying, of subtrees
1362 @cindex sorting, of subtrees
1363 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
1366 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1367 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1368 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a plain
1369 list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force creation of
1370 a new headline, use a prefix argument. When this command is used in the
1371 middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes the new
1372 headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the
1373 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the command is used at the
1374 beginning of a headline, the new headline is created before the current line.
1375 If at the beginning of any other line, the content of that line is made the
1376 new heading. If the command is used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e.@:
1377 behind the ellipses at the end of a headline), then a headline like the
1378 current one will be inserted after the end of the subtree.
1379 @orgcmd{C-@key{RET},org-insert-heading-respect-content}
1380 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
1381 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
1382 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
1383 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
1384 @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1385 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1386 variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
1387 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content}
1388 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1389 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1391 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1392 In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1393 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1394 and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1395 to the initial level.
1396 @orgcmd{M-@key{left},org-do-promote}
1397 Promote current heading by one level.
1398 @orgcmd{M-@key{right},org-do-demote}
1399 Demote current heading by one level.
1400 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-promote-subtree}
1401 Promote the current subtree by one level.
1402 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-demote-subtree}
1403 Demote the current subtree by one level.
1404 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-move-subtree-up}
1405 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1407 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-move-subtree-down}
1408 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1409 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-cut-subtree}
1410 Kill subtree, i.e.@: remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
1411 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
1412 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-copy-subtree}
1413 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1414 sequential subtrees.
1415 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-paste-subtree}
1416 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
1417 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1418 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
1419 headline marker like @samp{****}.
1420 @orgcmd{C-y,org-yank}
1421 @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1422 @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
1423 Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1424 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1425 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
1426 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1427 but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1428 previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1429 @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1430 force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1431 yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1433 @orgcmd{C-c C-x c,org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}
1434 Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1435 prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1436 timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1437 to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1438 more details, see the docstring of the command
1439 @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
1440 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
1441 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
1442 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-sort}
1443 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1444 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1445 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
1446 alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1447 creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1448 (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1449 of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1450 your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1451 sorting will be case-sensitive.
1452 @orgcmd{C-x n s,org-narrow-to-subtree}
1453 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1454 @orgcmd{C-x n b,org-narrow-to-block}
1455 Narrow buffer to current block.
1456 @orgcmd{C-x n w,widen}
1457 Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
1458 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-toggle-heading}
1459 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1460 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1461 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1462 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1463 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1464 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1467 @cindex region, active
1468 @cindex active region
1469 @cindex transient mark mode
1470 When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
1471 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1472 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1473 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1474 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1475 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1479 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
1480 @section Sparse trees
1481 @cindex sparse trees
1482 @cindex trees, sparse
1483 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1484 @cindex occur, command
1486 @vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
1487 @vindex org-show-following-heading
1488 @vindex org-show-siblings
1489 @vindex org-show-entry-below
1490 An important feature of Org mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1491 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1492 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1493 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1494 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1495 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1496 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1497 and you will see immediately how it works.
1499 Org mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1500 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1503 @orgcmd{C-c /,org-sparse-tree}
1504 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1505 @orgcmd{C-c / r,org-occur}
1506 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
1507 Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1508 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1509 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1510 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1511 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1512 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1513 editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
1514 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1515 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1516 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1517 @orgcmdkkc{M-g n,M-g M-n,next-error}
1518 Jump to the next sparse tree match in this buffer.
1519 @orgcmdkkc{M-g p,M-g M-p,previous-error}
1520 Jump to the previous sparse tree match in this buffer.
1525 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
1526 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1527 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1528 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1529 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1533 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1534 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1537 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1538 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1540 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1541 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1544 @cindex printing sparse trees
1545 @cindex visible text, printing
1546 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1547 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1548 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1549 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1550 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1551 part of the document and print the resulting file.
1553 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1554 @section Plain lists
1556 @cindex lists, plain
1557 @cindex lists, ordered
1558 @cindex ordered lists
1560 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1561 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of checkboxes
1562 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists, and every exporter
1563 (@pxref{Exporting}) can parse and format them.
1565 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1568 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1569 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1570 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1571 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star may
1572 be hard to distinguish from true headlines. In short: even though @samp{*}
1573 is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.} as
1576 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1577 @vindex org-alphabetical-lists
1578 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1579 a right parenthesis@footnote{You can filter out any of them by configuring
1580 @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}.}, such as @samp{1.} or
1581 @samp{1)}@footnote{You can also get @samp{a.}, @samp{A.}, @samp{a)} and
1582 @samp{A)} by configuring @code{org-alphabetical-lists}. To minimize
1583 confusion with normal text, those are limited to one character only. Beyond
1584 that limit, bullets will automatically fallback to numbers.}. If you want a
1585 list to start with a different value (e.g.@: 20), start the text of the item
1586 with @code{[@@20]}@footnote{If there's a checkbox in the item, the cookie
1587 must be put @emph{before} the checkbox. If you have activated alphabetical
1588 lists, you can also use counters like @code{[@@b]}.}. Those constructs can
1589 be used in any item of the list in order to enforce a particular numbering.
1591 @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
1592 separator @samp{ :: } to distinguish the description @emph{term} from the
1596 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1597 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1598 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1599 list. An item ends before the next line that is less or equally indented
1600 than its bullet/number.
1602 @vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
1603 A list ends whenever every item has ended, which means before any line less
1604 or equally indented than items at top level. It also ends before two blank
1605 lines@footnote{See also @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.}. In
1606 that case, all items are closed. Here is an example:
1610 ** Lord of the Rings
1611 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1612 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1613 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1614 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1615 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1616 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1618 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1619 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1620 Important actors in this film are:
1621 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1622 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1623 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
1627 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1628 them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
1629 XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
1630 put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
1631 properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
1632 structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
1633 blocks can be indented to signal that they belong to a particular item.
1635 @vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
1636 @vindex org-list-indent-offset
1637 If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
1638 the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
1639 @code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}. To get a greater difference of
1640 indentation between items and theirs sub-items, customize
1641 @code{org-list-indent-offset}.
1643 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1644 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line of
1645 an item (the line with the bullet or number). Some of them imply the
1646 application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact. If some of
1647 these actions get in your way, configure @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
1648 to disable them individually.
1651 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1652 @cindex cycling, in plain lists
1653 @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1654 Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1655 the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1656 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. If this variable is set to
1657 @code{integrate}, plain list items will be treated like low-level
1658 headlines. The level of an item is then given by the indentation of the
1659 bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real headlines, however; the
1660 hierarchies remain completely separated. In a new item with no text yet, the
1661 first @key{TAB} demotes the item to become a child of the previous
1662 one. Subsequent @key{TAB}s move the item to meaningful levels in the list
1663 and eventually get it back to its initial position.
1664 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1665 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1666 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1667 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1668 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1669 of an item, that item is @emph{split} in two, and the second part becomes the
1670 new item@footnote{If you do not want the item to be split, customize the
1671 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed
1672 @emph{before item's body}, the new item is created @emph{before} the current
1677 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1679 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1680 @kindex S-@key{down}
1683 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1684 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1685 @vindex org-list-use-circular-motion
1686 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list@footnote{If you want to
1687 cycle around items that way, you may customize
1688 @code{org-list-use-circular-motion}.}, but only if
1689 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1690 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1693 @kindex M-@key{down}
1696 Move the item including subitems up/down@footnote{See
1697 @code{org-liste-use-circular-motion} for a cyclic behavior.} (swap with
1698 previous/next item of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering
1700 @kindex M-@key{left}
1701 @kindex M-@key{right}
1704 Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
1705 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1706 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1709 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1710 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. When
1711 these commands are executed several times in direct succession, the initially
1712 selected region is used, even if the new indentation would imply a different
1713 hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break the command chain with a cursor
1716 As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a list will
1717 move the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by configuring
1718 @code{org-list-automatic-rules}. The global indentation of a list has no
1719 influence on the text @emph{after} the list.
1722 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1723 state of the checkbox. In any case, verify bullets and indentation
1724 consistency in the whole list.
1726 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1727 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1729 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1730 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}) or a subset of them,
1731 depending on @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}, the type of list,
1732 and its position@footnote{See @code{bullet} rule in
1733 @code{org-list-automatic-rules} for more information.}. With a numeric
1734 prefix argument N, select the Nth bullet from this list. If there is an
1735 active region when calling this, selected text will be changed into an item.
1736 With a prefix argument, all lines will be converted to list items. If the
1737 first line already was a list item, any item marker will be removed from the
1738 list. Finally, even without an active region, a normal line will be
1739 converted into a list item.
1742 Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1743 its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
1746 Turn the whole plain list into a subtree of the current heading. Checkboxes
1747 (@pxref{Checkboxes}) will become TODO (resp. DONE) keywords when unchecked
1749 @kindex S-@key{left}
1750 @kindex S-@key{right}
1752 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1753 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1754 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1755 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1758 Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1759 numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
1762 @node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
1766 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1769 @cindex org-insert-drawer
1771 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1772 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org mode has @emph{drawers}.
1773 Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1774 @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define additional drawers on a
1775 per-file basis with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN STATE}}. Drawers
1779 ** This is a headline
1780 Still outside the drawer
1782 This is inside the drawer.
1787 You can interactively insert drawers at point by calling
1788 @code{org-insert-drawer}, which is bound to @key{C-c C-x d}. With an active
1789 region, this command will put the region inside the drawer. With a prefix
1790 argument, this command calls @code{org-insert-property-drawer} and add a
1791 property drawer right below the current headline. Completion over drawer
1792 keywords is also possible using @key{M-TAB}.
1794 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1795 show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1796 look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1797 press @key{TAB} there. Org mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1798 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
1799 for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1800 (@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
1801 want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way to state changes, use
1806 Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
1809 @node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
1812 @vindex org-hide-block-startup
1813 @cindex blocks, folding
1814 Org mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1815 code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1816 information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1817 unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1818 folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1819 or on a per-file basis by using
1821 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1822 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1824 #+STARTUP: hideblocks
1825 #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1828 @node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
1832 Org mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1833 @file{footnote.el} package, Org mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
1834 larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
1835 syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e.@: a footnote is
1836 defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
1837 brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
1838 inside a footnote, use the @LaTeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
1839 is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1842 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1844 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1847 Org mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1848 optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1849 @file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
1850 encouraged because of possible conflicts with @LaTeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
1851 @LaTeX{}}). Here are the valid references:
1855 A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
1856 recommended because something like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
1859 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1860 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1861 @item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1862 A @LaTeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1864 @item [fn:name: a definition]
1865 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1866 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
1867 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1870 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1871 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
1872 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1873 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords. See the docstring of that variable
1876 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1881 The footnote action command.
1883 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1884 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1886 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1887 @vindex org-footnote-section
1888 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
1889 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
1890 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1891 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1892 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1893 separately into the location determined by the variable
1894 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1896 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1899 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1900 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1901 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1902 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1903 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1904 @r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1905 r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1906 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
1907 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1908 S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
1909 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1910 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1911 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1912 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g.@: sending}
1913 @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
1914 @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
1915 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1918 Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
1919 corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
1920 renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
1925 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
1926 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
1927 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
1931 @item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
1932 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
1933 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
1936 @node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
1937 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
1938 @cindex Orgstruct mode
1939 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
1941 If you like the intuitive way the Org mode structure editing and list
1942 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
1943 Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
1944 this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
1945 turn it on by default, for example in Message mode, with one of:
1948 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
1949 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
1952 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
1953 headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
1954 will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
1955 major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
1956 lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadows. When you use
1957 @code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
1958 settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
1961 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
1964 @cindex editing tables
1966 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
1967 calculations are supported using the Emacs @file{calc} package
1968 (@pxref{Top, Calc, , calc, Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
1971 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
1972 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
1973 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
1974 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
1975 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
1976 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
1979 @node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
1980 @section The built-in table editor
1981 @cindex table editor, built-in
1983 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with @samp{|} as
1984 the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a table. @samp{|}
1985 is also the column separator@footnote{To insert a vertical bar into a table
1986 field, use @code{\vert} or, inside a word @code{abc\vert@{@}def}.}. A table
1987 might look like this:
1990 | Name | Phone | Age |
1991 |-------+-------+-----|
1992 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
1993 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
1996 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
1997 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
1998 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
1999 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
2000 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
2001 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
2002 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
2003 create the above table, you would only type
2010 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
2011 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
2012 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
2014 @vindex org-enable-table-editor
2015 @vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
2016 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
2017 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
2018 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
2019 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
2020 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
2021 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
2022 unpredictable for you, configure the variables
2023 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
2026 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
2027 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2028 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
2029 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
2030 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
2031 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
2032 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
2033 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
2034 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
2036 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
2037 table. But it is easier just to start typing, like
2038 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
2040 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
2041 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-table-align}
2042 Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
2044 @orgcmd{<TAB>,org-table-next-field}
2045 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
2048 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-table-previous-field}
2049 Re-align, move to previous field.
2051 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-table-next-row}
2052 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
2053 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
2054 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
2056 @orgcmd{M-a,org-table-beginning-of-field}
2057 Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
2058 @orgcmd{M-e,org-table-end-of-field}
2059 Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
2061 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
2062 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{left},M-@key{right},org-table-move-column-left,org-table-move-column-right}
2063 Move the current column left/right.
2065 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-table-delete-column}
2066 Kill the current column.
2068 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-table-insert-column}
2069 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
2071 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-move-row-up,org-table-move-row-down}
2072 Move the current row up/down.
2074 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-table-kill-row}
2075 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
2077 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-table-insert-row}
2078 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
2079 created below the current one.
2081 @orgcmd{C-c -,org-table-insert-hline}
2082 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
2083 is created above the current line.
2085 @orgcmd{C-c @key{RET},org-table-hline-and-move}
2086 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
2089 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-table-sort-lines}
2090 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
2091 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
2092 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
2093 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
2094 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
2095 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
2096 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
2097 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
2098 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
2100 @tsubheading{Regions}
2101 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-table-copy-region}
2102 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
2103 mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
2104 copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
2106 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-table-cut-region}
2107 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
2108 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
2110 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-table-paste-rectangle}
2111 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
2112 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
2113 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
2114 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
2117 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-table-wrap-region}
2118 Split the current field at the cursor position and move the rest to the line
2119 below. If there is an active region, and both point and mark are in the same
2120 column, the text in the column is wrapped to minimum width for the given
2121 number of lines. A numeric prefix argument may be used to change the number
2122 of desired lines. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument,
2123 the current field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field
2126 @tsubheading{Calculations}
2127 @cindex formula, in tables
2128 @cindex calculations, in tables
2129 @cindex region, active
2130 @cindex active region
2131 @cindex transient mark mode
2132 @orgcmd{C-c +,org-table-sum}
2133 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
2134 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
2135 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
2137 @orgcmd{S-@key{RET},org-table-copy-down}
2138 @vindex org-table-copy-increment
2139 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
2140 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
2141 Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
2142 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
2143 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
2144 increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
2145 (@pxref{Conflicts}).
2147 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
2148 @orgcmd{C-c `,org-table-edit-field}
2149 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
2150 are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
2151 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
2152 edited in place. When called with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes, make the editor
2153 window follow the cursor through the table and always show the current
2154 field. The follow mode exits automatically when the cursor leaves the table,
2155 or when you repeat this command with @kbd{C-u C-u C-c `}.
2157 @item M-x org-table-import
2158 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
2159 separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
2160 from a database, because these programs generally can write
2161 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
2162 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
2163 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
2165 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2166 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
2167 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
2168 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
2170 @item M-x org-table-export
2171 @findex org-table-export
2172 @vindex org-table-export-default-format
2173 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
2174 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
2175 used to export the file can be configured in the variable
2176 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
2177 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
2178 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
2179 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
2180 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
2181 detailed description.
2184 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
2185 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
2189 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
2192 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
2193 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
2195 @node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
2196 @section Column width and alignment
2197 @cindex narrow columns in tables
2198 @cindex alignment in tables
2200 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
2201 also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
2202 of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
2204 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
2205 inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
2206 columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set@footnote{This
2207 feature does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere
2208 in the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
2209 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align
2210 will then set the width of this column to this value.
2214 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2216 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
2217 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
2218 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
2219 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
2220 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2225 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
2226 Note that the full text is still in the buffer but is hidden.
2227 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
2228 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
2229 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
2230 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
2233 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
2234 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
2235 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
2236 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
2237 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
2238 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
2239 on a per-file basis with:
2246 If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
2247 to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you can use @samp{<r>},
2248 @samp{c}@footnote{Centering does not work inside Emacs, but it does have an
2249 effect when exporting to HTML.} or @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may
2250 also combine alignment and field width like this: @samp{<l10>}.
2252 Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
2253 automatically when exporting the document.
2255 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
2256 @section Column groups
2257 @cindex grouping columns in tables
2259 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
2260 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
2261 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
2262 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
2263 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
2264 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
2265 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
2266 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} (no space between @samp{<}
2267 and @samp{>}) to make a column
2268 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
2269 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
2272 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2273 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2274 | / | < | | > | < | > |
2275 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
2276 | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
2277 | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
2278 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2279 #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
2282 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
2283 every vertical line you would like to have:
2286 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2287 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2291 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
2292 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
2294 @cindex minor mode for tables
2296 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
2297 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
2298 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
2299 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
2300 example in Message mode, use
2303 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
2306 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
2307 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
2308 construct @LaTeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
2309 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
2310 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
2312 @node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
2313 @section The spreadsheet
2314 @cindex calculations, in tables
2315 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
2316 @cindex @file{calc} package
2318 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
2319 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
2320 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
2321 is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
2322 of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
2323 column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
2324 also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
2325 fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
2326 formula, moving these references by arrow keys
2329 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
2330 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
2331 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
2332 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
2333 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
2334 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2335 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2336 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2337 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
2340 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
2341 @subsection References
2344 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
2345 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
2346 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
2347 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
2348 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
2350 @subsubheading Field references
2351 @cindex field references
2352 @cindex references, to fields
2354 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
2355 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
2356 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
2357 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2358 However, Org prefers@footnote{Org will understand references typed by the
2359 user as @samp{B4}, but it will not use this syntax when offering a formula
2360 for editing. You can customize this behavior using the variable
2361 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.} to use another, more general
2362 representation that looks like this:
2364 @@@var{row}$@var{column}
2367 Column specifications can be absolute like @code{$1},
2368 @code{$2},...@code{$@var{N}}, or relative to the current column (i.e.@: the
2369 column of the field which is being computed) like @code{$+1} or @code{$-2}.
2370 @code{$<} and @code{$>} are immutable references to the first and last
2371 column, respectively, and you can use @code{$>>>} to indicate the third
2372 column from the right.
2374 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal separator
2375 lines (hlines). Like with columns, you can use absolute row numbers
2376 @code{@@1}, @code{@@2},...@code{@@@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the
2377 current row like @code{@@+3} or @code{@@-1}. @code{@@<} and @code{@@>} are
2378 immutable references the first and last@footnote{For backward compatibility
2379 you can also use special names like @code{$LR5} and @code{$LR12} to refer in
2380 a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the table.
2381 However, this syntax is deprecated, it should not be used for new documents.
2382 Use @code{@@>$} instead.} row in the table, respectively. You may also
2383 specify the row relative to one of the hlines: @code{@@I} refers to the first
2384 hline, @code{@@II} to the second, etc@. @code{@@-I} refers to the first such
2385 line above the current line, @code{@@+I} to the first such line below the
2386 current line. You can also write @code{@@III+2} which is the second data line
2387 after the third hline in the table.
2389 @code{@@0} and @code{$0} refer to the current row and column, respectively,
2390 i.e. to the row/column for the field being computed. Also, if you omit
2391 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current row/column is
2394 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
2395 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
2396 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
2397 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
2398 references because the same reference operator can reference different
2399 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2401 Here are a few examples:
2404 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column (same as @code{C2})}
2405 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row (same as @code{E&})}
2406 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2407 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2408 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2409 @@>$5 @r{field in the last row, in column 5}
2412 @subsubheading Range references
2413 @cindex range references
2414 @cindex references, to ranges
2416 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2417 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2418 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2419 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2420 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2421 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2424 $1..$3 @r{first three fields in the current row}
2425 $P..$Q @r{range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2426 $<<<..$>> @r{start in third column, continue to the one but last}
2427 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields (same as @code{A2..C4})}
2428 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row}
2429 @@I..II @r{between first and second hline, short for @code{@@I..@@II}}
2432 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2433 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
2434 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
2435 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
2436 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
2438 @subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
2439 @cindex field coordinates
2440 @cindex coordinates, of field
2441 @cindex row, of field coordinates
2442 @cindex column, of field coordinates
2444 For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas @code{@@#} and @code{$#} can be used to
2445 get the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
2446 The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline}
2447 and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
2450 if(@@# % 2, $#, string("")) @r{column number on odd lines only}
2451 $3 = remote(FOO, @@@@#$2) @r{copy column 2 from table FOO into}
2452 @r{column 3 of the current table}
2455 @noindent For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows
2456 as the current table. Note that this is inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as
2457 O(N^2) because table FOO is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large
2460 @subsubheading Named references
2461 @cindex named references
2462 @cindex references, named
2463 @cindex name, of column or field
2464 @cindex constants, in calculations
2467 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
2468 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2469 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
2470 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2474 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2478 @vindex constants-unit-system
2479 @pindex constants.el
2480 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
2481 constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
2482 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2483 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2484 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2485 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
2486 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
2487 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2488 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2489 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2490 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2491 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2492 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2493 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2496 @subsubheading Remote references
2497 @cindex remote references
2498 @cindex references, remote
2499 @cindex references, to a different table
2500 @cindex name, of column or field
2501 @cindex constants, in calculations
2504 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2505 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2508 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2512 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2513 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2514 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2515 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2516 described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2519 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2520 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2521 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2522 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2524 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2525 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2526 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2527 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2528 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
2529 Your Programs, calc-eval, Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs, calc, GNU
2530 Emacs Calc Manual}),
2531 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
2532 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2533 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2534 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2536 @cindex format specifier
2537 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2538 @vindex org-calc-default-modes
2539 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2540 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2541 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2542 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2543 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
2544 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
2545 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2548 p20 @r{set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits}
2549 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{Normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed}
2550 @r{format of the result of Calc passed back to Org.}
2551 @r{Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as}
2552 @r{long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.}
2553 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
2554 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
2555 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
2556 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
2561 Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation
2562 and -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
2563 @code{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
2564 passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
2565 formatting@footnote{The @code{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
2566 because the value passed to it is converted into an @code{integer} or
2567 @code{double}. The @code{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
2568 signed value to 32 bits. The @code{double} is limited in precision to 64
2569 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}.
2573 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2574 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2575 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2576 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2577 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2578 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2579 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2580 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2581 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
2582 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2583 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2586 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
2589 if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{"teen" if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
2592 Note that you can also use two org-specific flags @code{T} and @code{t} for
2593 durations computations @ref{Durations and time values}.
2595 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Durations and time values, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2596 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2597 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2599 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp; this can be useful for
2600 string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's functionality is not
2601 enough. If a formula starts with a single-quote followed by an opening
2602 parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a Lisp form. The evaluation should
2603 return either a string or a number. Just as with @file{calc} formulas, you
2604 can specify modes and a printf format after a semicolon. With Emacs Lisp
2605 forms, you need to be conscious about the way field references are
2606 interpolated into the form. By default, a reference will be interpolated as
2607 a Lisp string (in double-quotes) containing the field. If you provide the
2608 @samp{N} mode switch, all referenced elements will be numbers (non-number
2609 fields will be zero) and interpolated as Lisp numbers, without quotes. If
2610 you provide the @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated literally,
2611 without quotes. I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted as a string
2612 by the Lisp form, enclose the reference operator itself in double-quotes,
2613 like @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated fields, so you can
2614 embed them in list or vector syntax. Here are a few examples---note how the
2615 @samp{N} mode is used when we do computations in Lisp:
2618 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
2619 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2620 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
2622 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
2623 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2626 @node Durations and time values, Field and range formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2627 @subsection Durations and time values
2628 @cindex Duration, computing
2629 @cindex Time, computing
2630 @vindex org-table-duration-custom-format
2632 If you want to compute time values use the @code{T} flag, either in Calc
2633 formulas or Elisp formulas:
2637 | Task 1 | Task 2 | Total |
2638 |---------+----------+----------|
2639 | 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59:00 |
2640 | 3:02:20 | -2:07:00 | 0.92 |
2641 #+TBLFM: @@2$3=$1+$2;T::@@3$3=$1+$2;t
2645 Input duration values must be of the form @code{[HH:MM[:SS]}, where seconds
2646 are optional. With the @code{T} flag, computed durations will be displayed
2647 as @code{[HH:MM:SS} (see the first formula above). With the @code{t} flag,
2648 computed durations will be displayed according to the value of the variable
2649 @code{org-table-duration-custom-format}, which defaults to @code{'hours} and
2650 will display the result as a fraction of hours (see the second formula in the
2653 Negative duration values can be manipulated as well, and integers will be
2654 considered as seconds in addition and subtraction.
2656 @node Field and range formulas, Column formulas, Durations and time values, The spreadsheet
2657 @subsection Field and range formulas
2658 @cindex field formula
2659 @cindex range formula
2660 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2661 @cindex formula, for range of fields
2663 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the field,
2664 preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=vsum(@@II..III)}. When you press
2665 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2666 the formula will be stored as the formula for this field, evaluated, and the
2667 current field will be replaced with the result.
2670 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:} directly
2671 below the table. If you type the equation in the 4th field of the 3rd data
2672 line in the table, the formula will look like @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When
2673 inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows with the appropriate commands,
2674 @i{absolute references} (but not relative ones) in stored formulas are
2675 modified in order to still reference the same field. To avoid this from
2676 happening, in particular in range references, anchor ranges at the table
2677 borders (using @code{@@<}, @code{@@>}, @code{$<}, @code{$>}), or at hlines
2678 using the @code{@@I} notation. Automatic adaptation of field references does
2679 of cause not happen if you edit the table structure with normal editing
2680 commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2682 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the following
2686 @orgcmd{C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2687 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2688 formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2689 it to the current field, and stores it.
2692 The left-hand side of a formula can also be a special expression in order to
2693 assign the formula to a number of different fields. There is no keyboard
2694 shortcut to enter such range formulas. To add them, use the formula editor
2695 (@pxref{Editing and debugging formulas}) or edit the @code{#+TBLFM:} line
2700 Column formula, valid for the entire column. This is so common that Org
2701 treats these formulas in a special way, see @ref{Column formulas}.
2703 Row formula, applies to all fields in the specified row. @code{@@>=} means
2706 Range formula, applies to all fields in the given rectangular range. This
2707 can also be used to assign a formula to some but not all fields in a row.
2709 Named field, see @ref{Advanced features}.
2712 @node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field and range formulas, The spreadsheet
2713 @subsection Column formulas
2714 @cindex column formula
2715 @cindex formula, for table column
2717 When you assign a formula to a simple column reference like @code{$3=}, the
2718 same formula will be used in all fields of that column, with the following
2719 very convenient exceptions: (i) If the table contains horizontal separator
2720 hlines, everything before the first such line is considered part of the table
2721 @emph{header} and will not be modified by column formulas. (ii) Fields that
2722 already get a value from a field/range formula will be left alone by column
2723 formulas. These conditions make column formulas very easy to use.
2725 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2726 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2727 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2728 the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2729 and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2730 @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2731 column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2732 @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The
2733 left-hand side of a column formula can not be the name of column, it must be
2734 the numeric column reference or @code{$>}.
2736 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2740 @orgcmd{C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2741 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2742 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2743 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2744 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g.@: @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2745 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2748 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2749 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2750 @cindex formula editing
2751 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2753 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2754 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2755 field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2756 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2757 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2758 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2759 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2760 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2763 @orgcmdkkc{C-c =,C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2764 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2765 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field and range formulas}.
2766 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2767 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2768 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2769 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2770 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2771 @orgcmd{C-c ?,org-table-field-info}
2772 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2773 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2775 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2777 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using overlays
2778 (@command{org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays}). These are updated each
2779 time the table is aligned; you can force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2781 @findex org-table-toggle-formula-debugger
2783 Toggle the formula debugger on and off
2784 (@command{org-table-toggle-formula-debugger}). See below.
2785 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-table-edit-formulas}
2786 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2787 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2788 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2789 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2790 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2791 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2793 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-x C-s,org-table-fedit-finish}
2794 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2795 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2796 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-table-fedit-abort}
2797 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2798 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type}
2799 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2800 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2801 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-table-fedit-lisp-indent}
2802 Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2803 a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
2804 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2805 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2806 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},lisp-complete-symbol}
2807 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2809 @kindex S-@key{down}
2810 @kindex S-@key{left}
2811 @kindex S-@key{right}
2812 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-up
2813 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-down
2814 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-left
2815 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-right
2816 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2817 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2818 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
2819 This also works for relative references and for hline references.
2820 @orgcmdkkcc{M-S-@key{up},M-S-@key{down},org-table-fedit-line-up,org-table-fedit-line-down}
2821 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2823 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-fedit-scroll-down,org-table-fedit-scroll-up}
2824 Scroll the window displaying the table.
2826 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2828 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2832 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
2833 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
2834 line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
2835 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2836 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2839 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
2840 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
2841 recalculation commands in the table.
2843 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
2844 @cindex formula debugging
2845 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
2846 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2847 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2848 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2849 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2850 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2851 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2853 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2854 @subsection Updating the table
2855 @cindex recomputing table fields
2856 @cindex updating, table
2858 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2859 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
2860 recalculation at least semi-automatic.
2862 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2866 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-table-recalculate}
2867 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2868 from left to right, and all field/range formulas in the current row.
2874 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2875 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2877 @orgcmdkkc{C-u C-u C-c *,C-u C-u C-c C-c,org-table-iterate}
2878 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2879 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2880 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2881 @item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2882 @findex org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2883 Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
2884 @item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2885 @findex org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2886 Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
2890 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2891 @subsection Advanced features
2893 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if you
2894 want to be able to assign @i{names}@footnote{Such names must start by an
2895 alphabetic character and use only alphanumeric/underscore characters.} to
2896 fields and columns, you need to reserve the first column of the table for
2897 special marking characters.
2900 @orgcmd{C-#,org-table-rotate-recalc-marks}
2901 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
2902 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2903 change all marks in the region.
2906 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2907 makes use of these features:
2911 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2912 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
2913 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2914 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
2915 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
2916 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
2917 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2918 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
2919 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
2920 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2921 | | Average | | | | 29.7 | |
2922 | ^ | | | | | at | |
2923 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
2924 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2925 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
2929 @noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
2930 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
2931 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
2932 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
2935 @cindex marking characters, tables
2936 The marking characters have the following meaning:
2939 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
2940 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
2942 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
2943 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
2944 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
2945 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
2947 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
2950 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
2951 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
2952 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
2953 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
2956 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
2957 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
2958 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
2959 lines will be left alone by this command.
2961 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
2962 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
2963 recalculation slows down editing too much.
2965 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
2966 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
2969 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
2970 @samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
2973 Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
2974 fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
2975 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
2980 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2981 | | Func | n | x | Result |
2982 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2983 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
2984 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
2985 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
2986 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
2987 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
2988 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
2989 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2990 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
2994 @node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
2996 @cindex graph, in tables
2997 @cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
3000 Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
3001 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
3002 @uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html}. To see
3003 this in action, ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed
3004 on your system, then call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
3008 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
3009 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
3010 |-----------+-----------+---------|
3011 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
3012 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
3013 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
3014 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
3015 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
3019 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
3020 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
3021 be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
3022 for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
3023 see the Org-plot tutorial at
3024 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.html}.
3026 @subsubheading Plot Options
3030 Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
3033 Specify the title of the plot.
3036 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
3039 Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
3040 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
3041 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
3045 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
3048 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
3049 (e.g.@: @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
3050 Defaults to @code{lines}.
3053 If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
3056 List of labels to be used for the @code{deps} (defaults to the column headers
3060 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
3063 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
3064 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
3067 Specify format of Org mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
3068 Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
3071 If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
3072 between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
3073 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
3074 the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
3075 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
3079 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
3083 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
3084 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
3087 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
3088 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
3089 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
3090 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
3091 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
3092 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
3093 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
3094 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
3097 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
3098 @section Link format
3100 @cindex format, of links
3102 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
3103 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
3106 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
3110 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
3111 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
3112 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
3113 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
3114 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
3115 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
3116 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
3117 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
3120 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
3121 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
3122 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
3123 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
3124 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
3125 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
3126 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
3128 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
3129 @section Internal links
3130 @cindex internal links
3131 @cindex links, internal
3132 @cindex targets, for links
3134 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3135 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
3136 current file. The most important case is a link like
3137 @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
3138 @code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
3139 for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
3140 links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
3143 Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
3144 lead to a text search in the current file.
3146 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
3147 or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
3148 point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
3149 a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
3150 may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
3151 comment line. For example
3157 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
3158 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
3159 text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
3160 target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
3163 If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for a headline that is exactly
3164 the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and tags@footnote{To insert
3165 a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. Just type a
3166 star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and press
3167 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be offered as
3168 completions.}. In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the
3169 link text. In the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
3171 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
3172 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
3173 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
3177 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
3180 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
3181 @subsection Radio targets
3182 @cindex radio targets
3183 @cindex targets, radio
3184 @cindex links, radio targets
3186 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
3187 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
3188 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
3189 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
3190 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
3191 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
3192 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
3193 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3194 cursor on or at a target.
3196 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
3197 @section External links
3198 @cindex links, external
3199 @cindex external links
3200 @cindex links, external
3208 @cindex WANDERLUST links
3210 @cindex USENET links
3215 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
3216 BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
3217 logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
3218 identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
3219 the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
3222 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
3223 doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
3224 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
3225 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
3226 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
3227 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3228 file:/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
3229 /myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3230 file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file, jump to line number}
3231 file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
3232 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}@footnote{
3233 The actual behavior of the search will depend on the value of
3234 the variable @code{org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline}. If its value
3235 is nil, then a fuzzy text search will be done. If it is t, then only the
3236 exact headline will be matched. If the value is @code{'query-to-create},
3237 then an exact headline will be searched; if it is not found, then the user
3238 will be queried to create it.}
3239 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
3240 file+sys:/path/to/file @r{open via OS, like double-click}
3241 file+emacs:/path/to/file @r{force opening by Emacs}
3242 docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open in doc-view mode at page}
3243 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
3244 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
3245 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
3246 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
3247 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
3248 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
3249 vm-imap:account:folder @r{VM IMAP folder link}
3250 vm-imap:account:folder#id @r{VM IMAP message link}
3251 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
3252 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
3253 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
3254 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
3255 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
3256 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
3257 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
3258 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
3259 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
3260 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
3261 info:org#External links @r{Info node link}
3262 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
3263 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
3264 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
3267 For customizing Org to add new link types @ref{Adding hyperlink types}.
3269 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
3270 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
3271 format}), for example:
3274 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
3278 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
3279 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
3280 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
3282 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
3284 @cindex square brackets, around links
3285 @cindex plain text external links
3286 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
3287 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
3288 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
3289 about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
3291 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
3292 @section Handling links
3293 @cindex links, handling
3295 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
3296 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
3299 @orgcmd{C-c l,org-store-link}
3300 @cindex storing links
3301 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
3302 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
3303 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
3304 buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
3307 @b{Org mode buffers}@*
3308 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
3309 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
3310 be the description@footnote{If the headline contains a timestamp, it will be
3311 removed from the link and result in a wrong link -- you should avoid putting
3312 timestamp in the headline.}.
3314 @vindex org-link-to-org-use-id
3315 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3316 @cindex property, ID
3317 If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
3318 will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
3319 @code{org-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will be
3320 created and/or used to construct a link. So using this command in Org
3321 buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
3322 ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
3323 file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
3326 @b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
3327 Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
3328 current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
3329 constructed from the author and the subject.
3331 @b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
3332 Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
3334 @b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
3335 Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
3338 @vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
3339 For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
3340 @code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
3341 the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
3342 the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
3345 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
3346 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
3347 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
3348 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
3349 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
3350 and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
3351 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
3354 When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
3355 entry referenced by the current line.
3358 @orgcmd{C-c C-l,org-insert-link}
3359 @cindex link completion
3360 @cindex completion, of links
3361 @cindex inserting links
3362 @vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
3363 Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
3364 insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
3365 straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
3366 enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
3367 descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
3368 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
3369 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
3370 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
3371 removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
3372 a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
3373 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
3374 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
3375 becomes the default description.
3377 @b{Inserting stored links}@*
3378 All links stored during the
3379 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
3380 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
3382 @b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
3383 valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
3384 defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
3385 press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
3386 specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
3387 calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
3388 example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
3389 access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
3390 @key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
3392 @cindex file name completion
3393 @cindex completion, of file names
3394 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
3395 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
3396 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
3397 directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
3398 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
3399 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
3400 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
3401 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
3403 @item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
3404 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
3405 link and description parts of the link.
3407 @cindex following links
3408 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
3409 @vindex org-file-apps
3410 @vindex org-link-frame-setup
3411 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
3412 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
3413 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
3414 cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
3415 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
3416 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
3417 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
3418 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
3419 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
3420 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
3421 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
3422 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
3423 If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
3424 headline and entry text. If you want to setup the frame configuration for
3425 following links, customize @code{org-link-frame-setup}.
3428 @vindex org-return-follows-link
3429 When @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, @kbd{@key{RET}} will also follow
3436 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
3437 would. Under Emacs 22 and later, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
3441 @vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
3442 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
3443 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
3444 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
3446 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-v,org-toggle-inline-images}
3447 @cindex inlining images
3448 @cindex images, inlining
3449 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
3450 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3451 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3452 Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
3453 images that have no description part in the link, i.e.@: images that will also
3454 be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
3455 images that do have a link description. You can ask for inline images to be
3456 displayed at startup by configuring the variable
3457 @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}@footnote{with corresponding
3458 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{inlineimages} and @code{inlineimages}}.
3459 @orgcmd{C-c %,org-mark-ring-push}
3461 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
3462 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
3464 @orgcmd{C-c &,org-mark-ring-goto}
3465 @cindex links, returning to
3466 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
3467 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
3468 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
3469 previously recorded positions.
3471 @orgcmdkkcc{C-c C-x C-n,C-c C-x C-p,org-next-link,org-previous-link}
3472 @cindex links, finding next/previous
3473 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
3474 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
3475 bindings for this are really too long; you might want to bind this also
3476 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
3478 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
3480 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
3481 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
3485 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
3486 @section Using links outside Org
3488 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
3489 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
3490 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
3494 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
3495 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
3498 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
3499 @section Link abbreviations
3500 @cindex link abbreviations
3501 @cindex abbreviation, links
3503 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3504 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3505 abbreviated link looks like this
3508 [[linkword:tag][description]]
3512 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3513 where the tag is optional.
3514 The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
3515 letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
3516 according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3517 that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
3521 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3522 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3523 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3524 ("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s")
3525 ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1")
3526 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3530 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3531 replaced with the tag. Otherwise the tag will be appended to the string
3532 in order to create the link. You may also specify a function that will
3533 be called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3535 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3536 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
3537 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]}, show the map location of the Free Software
3538 Foundation @code{[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]} or of Carsten office
3539 @code{[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]} and find out
3540 what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with
3541 @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3543 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
3544 can define them in the file with
3548 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3549 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3553 In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3554 complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
3555 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g.@: completion)
3556 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
3557 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
3559 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
3560 @section Search options in file links
3561 @cindex search option in file links
3562 @cindex file links, searching
3564 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3565 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3566 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3567 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3568 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3569 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3570 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
3571 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
3573 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3574 link, together with an explanation:
3577 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3578 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3579 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3580 [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
3581 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3588 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3589 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3590 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3591 link will become an HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3594 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
3596 Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
3598 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3599 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
3600 target file is in Org mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
3601 sparse tree with the matches.
3602 @c If the target file is a directory,
3603 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3606 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3607 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3608 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3609 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
3611 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
3612 @section Custom Searches
3613 @cindex custom search strings
3614 @cindex search strings, custom
3616 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3617 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
3618 cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
3619 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
3620 because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
3623 @vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3624 @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
3625 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3626 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3627 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3628 to be added to the hook variables
3629 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3630 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
3631 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
3632 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
3633 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
3635 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
3639 Org mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
3640 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
3641 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3642 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3643 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3644 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3645 item emerged is always present.
3647 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3648 throughout your notes file. Org mode compensates for this by providing
3649 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3652 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3653 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3654 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3655 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3656 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3657 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3660 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
3661 @section Basic TODO functionality
3663 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3664 @samp{TODO}, for example:
3667 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3671 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3674 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
3675 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
3676 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3679 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3680 '--------------------------------'
3683 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3684 agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3686 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-t}
3687 Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set up)
3688 the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to assign keys
3689 to TODO states, see @ref{Per-file keywords}, and @ref{Setting tags}, for
3692 @kindex S-@key{right}
3693 @kindex S-@key{left}
3694 @item S-@key{right} @ @r{/} @ S-@key{left}
3695 @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
3696 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3697 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
3698 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
3699 with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
3700 @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
3701 @orgcmd{C-c / t,org-show-todo-key}
3702 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3703 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3704 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
3705 entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
3706 headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
3707 / T}), search for a specific TODO. You will be prompted for the keyword, and
3708 you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
3709 entries that match any one of these keywords. With a numeric prefix argument
3710 N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable
3711 @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states,
3712 both un-done and done.
3713 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
3714 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
3715 from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new
3716 buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
3717 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3718 @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
3719 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
3720 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
3724 @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
3725 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
3726 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
3728 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
3729 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
3730 @cindex extended TODO keywords
3732 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3733 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
3734 DONE. Org mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
3735 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
3736 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
3739 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
3740 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
3743 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
3744 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
3745 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
3746 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
3747 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
3748 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
3749 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
3752 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
3753 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
3754 @cindex TODO workflow
3755 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
3757 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
3758 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
3759 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org mode in a
3763 (setq org-todo-keywords
3764 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
3767 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
3768 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
3769 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
3771 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
3772 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
3773 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED. You may
3774 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
3775 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY.
3776 Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
3777 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
3778 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
3779 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
3780 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
3781 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
3783 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
3784 @subsection TODO keywords as types
3786 @cindex names as TODO keywords
3787 @cindex types as TODO keywords
3789 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3790 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3791 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3792 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3793 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3794 be set up like this:
3797 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3800 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3801 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
3802 person, and later to mark it DONE. Org mode supports this style by adapting
3803 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3804 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3805 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3806 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3807 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3808 to DONE. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3809 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3810 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things
3811 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items
3812 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3813 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
3815 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
3816 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
3817 @cindex TODO keyword sets
3819 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3820 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3821 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3822 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3823 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3827 (setq org-todo-keywords
3828 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3829 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3830 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3833 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org mode to keep track
3834 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3835 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3836 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3837 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3838 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3839 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3842 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
3843 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
3844 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
3845 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
3846 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
3847 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
3848 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3849 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
3850 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
3851 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
3852 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
3853 @kindex S-@key{right}
3854 @kindex S-@key{left}
3857 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
3858 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
3859 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
3860 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3861 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3864 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3865 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
3867 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3868 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for
3869 single-letter access to the states. This is done by adding the section
3870 key after each keyword, in parentheses. For example:
3873 (setq org-todo-keywords
3874 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3875 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3876 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3879 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
3880 If you then press @kbd{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
3881 will be switched to this state. @kbd{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
3882 keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
3883 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
3884 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
3885 mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
3886 unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
3888 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
3889 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3890 @cindex keyword options
3891 @cindex per-file keywords
3896 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
3897 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
3898 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
3899 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
3900 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
3904 #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
3906 @noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
3907 interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
3909 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
3912 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
3916 #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
3920 @cindex completion, of option keywords
3922 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
3923 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
3925 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
3926 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
3927 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
3928 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
3929 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
3930 known to Org mode@footnote{Org mode parses these lines only when
3931 Org mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3932 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org mode
3933 for the current buffer.}.
3935 @node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
3936 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
3937 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
3939 @vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
3940 @vindex org-done @r{(face)}
3941 @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
3942 Org mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
3943 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
3944 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
3945 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
3946 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
3947 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
3951 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
3952 '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
3953 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
3957 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
3958 work, this does not always seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
3959 special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The variable
3960 @code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
3961 foreground or a background color.
3963 @node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
3964 @subsection TODO dependencies
3965 @cindex TODO dependencies
3966 @cindex dependencies, of TODO states
3968 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
3969 @cindex property, ORDERED
3970 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
3971 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
3972 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE. And sometimes
3973 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
3974 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
3975 the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
3976 from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE.
3977 Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
3978 will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE. Here is an
3982 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
3991 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
3992 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
3996 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
3997 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
3998 @cindex property, ORDERED
3999 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
4000 for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
4001 inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
4002 this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
4003 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4004 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t}
4005 Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
4008 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
4009 If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
4010 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
4011 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
4013 @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
4014 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4015 You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
4016 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
4017 @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
4018 checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
4020 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
4021 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
4022 module @file{org-depend.el}.
4025 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
4026 @section Progress logging
4027 @cindex progress logging
4028 @cindex logging, of progress
4030 Org mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
4031 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
4032 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
4033 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
4034 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
4038 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
4039 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
4040 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
4043 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
4044 @subsection Closing items
4046 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
4047 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
4048 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}
4051 (setq org-log-done 'time)
4055 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
4056 of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
4057 just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
4058 through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
4059 want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
4060 corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
4063 (setq org-log-done 'note)
4067 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
4068 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
4070 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
4071 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
4072 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
4073 giving you an overview of what has been done.
4075 @node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
4076 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
4077 @cindex drawer, for state change recording
4079 @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
4080 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
4081 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
4082 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
4083 might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
4084 note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
4085 time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
4086 headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
4087 @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
4088 want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
4089 Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this behavior---the
4090 recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}@footnote{Note that the
4091 @code{LOGBOOK} drawer is unfolded when pressing @key{SPC} in the agenda to
4092 show an entry---use @key{C-u SPC} to keep it folded here}. You can also
4093 overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
4094 @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
4096 Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org mode
4097 expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
4098 adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) or @samp{@@} (for a note
4099 with timestamp) in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the
4103 (setq org-todo-keywords
4104 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
4107 To record a timestamp without a note for TODO keywords configured with
4108 @samp{@@}, just type @kbd{C-c C-c} to enter a blank note when prompted.
4111 @vindex org-log-done
4112 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
4113 request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
4114 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org mode will record two timestamps
4115 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
4116 However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
4117 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
4118 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
4119 WAIT or CANCELED. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
4120 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
4121 entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
4122 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
4123 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
4124 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
4125 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
4126 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
4129 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
4132 #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
4135 @cindex property, LOGGING
4136 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
4137 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
4138 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
4139 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
4140 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
4141 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
4144 * TODO Log each state with only a time
4146 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
4148 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
4150 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
4152 * TODO No logging at all
4158 @node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
4159 @subsection Tracking your habits
4162 Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
4163 called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
4167 You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
4170 The habit is a TODO item, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
4172 The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
4174 The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a @code{.+} style repeat
4175 interval. A @code{++} style may be appropriate for habits with time
4176 constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a @code{+} style for an
4177 unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports.
4179 The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
4180 syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
4181 three days, but at most every two days.
4183 You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled, in order
4184 for historical data to be represented in the consistency graph. If it is not
4185 enabled it is not an error, but the consistency graphs will be largely
4189 To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
4190 actual habit with some history:
4194 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
4195 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
4196 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
4197 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
4198 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
4199 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
4200 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
4201 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
4202 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
4203 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
4204 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
4207 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
4211 What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
4212 @code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
4213 today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
4214 after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
4215 after four days have elapsed.
4217 What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
4218 consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
4219 done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
4220 past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
4224 If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
4226 If the task could have been done on that day.
4228 If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
4230 If the task was overdue on that day.
4233 In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
4234 the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
4235 the current day falls in the graph.
4237 There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
4238 habits are displayed in the agenda.
4241 @item org-habit-graph-column
4242 The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
4243 overwrite any text in that column, so it is a good idea to keep your habits'
4244 titles brief and to the point.
4245 @item org-habit-preceding-days
4246 The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
4247 @item org-habit-following-days
4248 The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
4249 @item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
4250 If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
4254 Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
4255 temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
4256 bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
4257 which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
4259 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
4263 If you use Org mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
4264 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
4265 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
4268 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
4272 @vindex org-priority-faces
4273 By default, Org mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
4274 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
4275 treated just like priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only for
4276 sorting in the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they
4277 have no inherent meaning to Org mode. The cookies can be highlighted with
4278 special faces by customizing the variable @code{org-priority-faces}.
4280 Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to be TODO
4286 @findex org-priority
4287 Set the priority of the current headline (@command{org-priority}). The
4288 command prompts for a priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}.
4289 When you press @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the
4290 headline. The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline
4291 and agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
4293 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-priority-up,org-priority-down}
4294 @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
4295 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
4296 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
4297 also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
4298 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
4299 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
4302 @vindex org-highest-priority
4303 @vindex org-lowest-priority
4304 @vindex org-default-priority
4305 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
4306 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
4307 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
4308 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
4309 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
4312 @cindex #+PRIORITIES
4317 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
4318 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
4319 @cindex tasks, breaking down
4320 @cindex statistics, for TODO items
4322 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
4323 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
4324 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
4325 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
4326 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
4327 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
4328 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
4329 be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
4330 @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
4333 * Organize Party [33%]
4334 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
4338 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
4341 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4342 If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
4343 the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
4344 @code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
4347 @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
4348 If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
4349 subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
4350 @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
4351 include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4355 * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
4357 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
4361 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
4362 when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
4365 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
4366 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
4367 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
4368 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
4370 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
4374 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
4375 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
4378 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
4382 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
4383 Every item in a plain list@footnote{With the exception of description
4384 lists. But you can allow it by modifying @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
4385 accordingly.} (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a checkbox by starting
4386 it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is similar to TODO items
4387 (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight. Checkboxes are not included
4388 into the global TODO list, so they are often great to split a task into a
4389 number of simple steps. Or you can use them in a shopping list. To toggle a
4390 checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's
4391 @file{org-mouse.el}).
4393 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
4396 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
4397 - [-] call people [1/3]
4402 - [ ] think about what music to play
4403 - [X] talk to the neighbors
4406 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
4407 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
4408 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
4411 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
4412 @cindex checkbox statistics
4413 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4414 @vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
4415 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
4416 indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
4417 and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
4418 many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
4419 be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
4420 Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
4421 headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
4422 @code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
4423 count all checkboxes below the cookie, not just those belonging to direct
4424 children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
4425 @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
4426 result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
4427 the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
4428 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
4429 count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
4430 will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4431 to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
4433 @cindex blocking, of checkboxes
4434 @cindex checkbox blocking
4435 @cindex property, ORDERED
4436 If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
4437 be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
4438 off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
4440 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
4443 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-toggle-checkbox}
4444 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point.
4445 With a single prefix argument, add an empty checkbox or remove the current
4446 one@footnote{`C-u C-c C-c' on the @emph{first} item of a list with no checkbox
4447 will add checkboxes to the rest of the list.}. With a double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is
4448 considered to be an intermediate state.
4449 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-b,org-toggle-checkbox}
4450 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4451 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4455 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
4456 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
4457 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
4459 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
4460 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
4462 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
4464 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
4465 Insert a new item with a checkbox. This works only if the cursor is already
4466 in a plain list item (@pxref{Plain lists}).
4467 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4468 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4469 @cindex property, ORDERED
4470 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
4471 be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
4472 this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
4473 However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
4474 for better visibility, customize the variable
4475 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4476 @orgcmd{C-c #,org-update-statistics-cookies}
4477 Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
4478 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
4479 updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
4480 new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
4481 changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
4482 hand, use this command to get things back into sync.
4485 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
4488 @cindex headline tagging
4489 @cindex matching, tags
4490 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
4492 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
4493 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org mode has extensive
4496 @vindex org-tag-faces
4497 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
4498 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
4499 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
4500 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
4501 Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
4502 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
4503 @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
4504 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4507 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4508 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4509 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4512 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
4513 @section Tag inheritance
4514 @cindex tag inheritance
4515 @cindex inheritance, of tags
4516 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4518 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4519 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4520 well. For example, in the list
4523 * Meeting with the French group :work:
4524 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4525 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4529 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4530 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
4531 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
4532 a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
4533 level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
4534 with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
4535 changes in the line.}:
4539 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4543 @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4544 @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
4545 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use
4546 the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and
4547 @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
4549 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4550 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
4551 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
4552 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
4553 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4554 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4555 match in a subtree, configure the variable
4556 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
4558 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
4559 @section Setting tags
4560 @cindex setting tags
4561 @cindex tags, setting
4564 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4565 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4566 also a special command for inserting tags:
4569 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-set-tags-command}
4570 @cindex completion, of tags
4571 @vindex org-tags-column
4572 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org mode will either offer
4573 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4574 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4575 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4576 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4577 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4578 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
4579 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-set-tags-command}
4580 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4583 @vindex org-tag-alist
4584 Org supports tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4585 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4586 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4587 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4588 the default tags for a given file with lines like
4592 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4593 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4596 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4597 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
4598 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4604 @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4605 If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4606 in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4607 you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4608 @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4609 by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4615 By default Org mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4616 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4617 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4618 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4619 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
4620 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
4621 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
4622 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4626 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
4629 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
4630 can instead set the TAGS option line as:
4633 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
4636 @noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
4637 window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
4638 @samp{\n} into the tag list
4641 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
4644 @noindent or write them in two lines:
4647 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
4648 #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
4652 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
4656 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
4659 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
4660 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
4662 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
4663 these lines to activate any changes.
4666 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
4667 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
4668 of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
4669 break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
4673 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
4674 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
4675 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
4677 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
4680 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
4681 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
4682 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
4683 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
4684 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
4689 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
4690 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
4691 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
4694 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
4695 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
4696 You can also add several tags: just separate them with a comma.
4700 Clear all tags for this line.
4703 Accept the modified set.
4705 Abort without installing changes.
4707 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
4709 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
4710 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
4712 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
4713 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
4718 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
4719 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
4720 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
4721 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
4722 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
4723 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
4724 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
4725 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
4727 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
4728 If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
4729 modify your list of tags, set the variable
4730 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
4731 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
4732 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
4733 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
4734 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
4735 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
4736 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
4737 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
4739 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
4740 @section Tag searches
4741 @cindex tag searches
4742 @cindex searching for tags
4744 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
4745 information into special lists.
4748 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \\,org-match-sparse-tree}
4749 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
4750 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4751 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4752 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
4753 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4754 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4755 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4756 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4757 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
4758 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4761 These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
4762 like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
4763 @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
4764 which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
4765 string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
4766 and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
4767 @ref{Matching tags and properties}.
4770 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
4771 @chapter Properties and columns
4774 A property is a key-value pair associated with an entry. Properties can be
4775 set so they are associated with a single entry, with every entry in a tree,
4776 or with every entry in an Org mode file.
4778 There are two main applications for properties in Org mode. First,
4779 properties are like tags, but with a value. Imagine maintaining a file where
4780 you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
4781 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, you can use a
4782 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
4783 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. Second, you can use properties to
4784 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. Imagine
4785 keeping track of your music CDs, where properties could be things such as the
4786 album, artist, date of release, number of tracks, and so on.
4788 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
4789 (@pxref{Column view}).
4792 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
4793 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
4794 * Property searches:: Matching property values
4795 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
4796 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
4797 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
4800 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
4801 @section Property syntax
4802 @cindex property syntax
4803 @cindex drawer, for properties
4805 Properties are key-value pairs. When they are associated with a single entry
4806 or with a tree they need to be inserted into a special
4807 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
4808 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
4809 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
4814 *** Goldberg Variations
4816 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4817 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4819 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4824 Depending on the value of @code{org-use-property-inheritance}, a property set
4825 this way will either be associated with a single entry, or the sub-tree
4826 defined by the entry, see @ref{Property inheritance}.
4828 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
4829 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
4830 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
4831 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
4832 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
4833 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
4834 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
4839 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
4840 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
4844 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
4845 file, use a line like
4846 @cindex property, _ALL
4849 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
4852 If you want to add to the value of an existing property, append a @code{+} to
4853 the property name. The following results in the property @code{var} having
4854 the value ``foo=1 bar=2''.
4857 #+PROPERTY: var foo=1
4858 #+PROPERTY: var+ bar=2
4861 It is also possible to add to the values of inherited properties. The
4862 following results in the @code{genres} property having the value ``Classic
4863 Baroque'' under the @code{Goldberg Variations} subtree.
4871 *** Goldberg Variations
4873 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4874 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4876 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4881 Note that a property can only have one entry per Drawer.
4883 @vindex org-global-properties
4884 Property values set with the global variable
4885 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
4889 The following commands help to work with properties:
4892 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},pcomplete}
4893 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
4894 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
4895 @orgcmd{C-c C-x p,org-set-property}
4896 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
4897 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
4898 @item C-u M-x org-insert-drawer
4899 @cindex org-insert-drawer
4900 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
4901 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
4902 information like deadlines.
4903 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-property-action}
4904 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
4905 @orgcmd{C-c C-c s,org-set-property}
4906 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
4907 can be inserted using completion.
4908 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{right},S-@key{left},org-property-next-allowed-value,org-property-previous-allowed-value}
4909 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
4910 @orgcmd{C-c C-c d,org-delete-property}
4911 Remove a property from the current entry.
4912 @orgcmd{C-c C-c D,org-delete-property-globally}
4913 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
4914 @orgcmd{C-c C-c c,org-compute-property-at-point}
4915 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
4916 nearest column format definition.
4919 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
4920 @section Special properties
4921 @cindex properties, special
4923 Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org mode features,
4924 like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the previous
4925 chapters. This interface exists so that you can include these states in a
4926 column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in queries. The following
4927 property names are special and (except for @code{:CATEGORY:}) should not be
4928 used as keys in the properties drawer:
4930 @cindex property, special, TODO
4931 @cindex property, special, TAGS
4932 @cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
4933 @cindex property, special, CATEGORY
4934 @cindex property, special, PRIORITY
4935 @cindex property, special, DEADLINE
4936 @cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
4937 @cindex property, special, CLOSED
4938 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
4939 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
4940 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
4941 @cindex property, special, BLOCKED
4942 @c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
4943 @cindex property, special, ITEM
4944 @cindex property, special, FILE
4946 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
4947 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
4948 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
4949 CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
4950 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
4951 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
4952 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
4953 CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
4954 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
4955 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
4956 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
4957 @r{must be run first to compute the values in the current buffer.}
4958 BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings}
4959 ITEM @r{The headline of the entry.}
4960 FILE @r{The filename the entry is located in.}
4963 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
4964 @section Property searches
4965 @cindex properties, searching
4966 @cindex searching, of properties
4968 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
4969 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
4971 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \,org-match-sparse-tree}
4972 Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
4973 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4974 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4975 Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
4976 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4977 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4978 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4979 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4980 only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
4981 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4984 The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
4987 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
4992 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
4993 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
4994 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
4995 value. If you enclose the value in curly braces, it is interpreted as
4996 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
4999 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
5000 @section Property Inheritance
5001 @cindex properties, inheritance
5002 @cindex inheritance, of properties
5004 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
5005 The outline structure of Org mode documents lends itself to an
5006 inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
5007 property, the children can inherit this property. Org mode does not
5008 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
5009 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
5010 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
5011 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
5012 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
5013 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
5014 inherited properties. If a property has the value @samp{nil}, this is
5015 interpreted as an explicit undefine of the property, so that inheritance
5016 search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
5018 Org mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
5019 least for the special applications for which they are used:
5021 @cindex property, COLUMNS
5024 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
5025 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
5026 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
5027 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
5028 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
5030 @cindex property, CATEGORY
5031 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
5032 applies to the entire subtree.
5034 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
5035 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
5036 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
5038 @cindex property, LOGGING
5039 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
5040 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
5043 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
5044 @section Column view
5046 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
5047 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
5048 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
5049 entries. Org mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
5050 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
5051 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
5052 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
5053 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
5054 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
5055 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
5056 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
5057 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
5058 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
5061 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
5062 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
5063 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
5066 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
5067 @subsection Defining columns
5068 @cindex column view, for properties
5069 @cindex properties, column view
5071 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
5072 done by defining a column format line.
5075 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
5076 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
5079 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
5080 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
5082 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
5086 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5089 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
5090 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
5093 ** Top node for columns view
5095 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5099 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
5100 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
5101 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
5102 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
5103 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
5104 deeper part of the tree.
5106 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
5107 @subsubsection Column attributes
5108 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
5109 definition looks like this:
5112 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
5116 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
5117 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
5120 @var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
5121 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
5122 @var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
5123 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
5124 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
5125 @var{title} @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the property}
5127 @{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
5128 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
5129 @r{Supported summary types are:}
5130 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
5131 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
5132 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
5133 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.}
5134 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
5135 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
5136 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
5137 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
5138 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
5139 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
5140 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
5141 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
5142 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
5143 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5144 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5145 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5146 @{est+@} @r{Add low-high estimates.}
5150 Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
5151 include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
5152 same summary information.
5154 The @code{est+} summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
5155 combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example, instead
5156 of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it as
5157 5-6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much work is required, or
5158 1-10 days if you don't really know what needs to be done. Both ranges
5159 average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more predictable delivery.
5161 When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs
5162 produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, @code{est+} adds the
5163 statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final estimate
5164 from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was
5165 estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate
5166 of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either
5167 extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, @code{est+} estimates the
5168 full job more realistically, at 10-15 days.
5170 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
5174 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
5175 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
5176 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
5177 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
5178 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
5182 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
5183 item itself, i.e.@: of the headline. You probably always should start the
5184 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
5185 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
5186 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
5187 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
5188 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
5189 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
5190 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
5191 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
5192 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
5193 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
5194 @samp{CLOCKSUM} column is special, it lists the sum of CLOCK intervals
5197 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
5198 @subsection Using column view
5201 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
5202 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-columns}
5203 @vindex org-columns-default-format
5204 Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
5205 column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
5206 definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
5207 searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
5208 defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
5209 for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
5210 property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
5211 @code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
5212 and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
5213 @orgcmd{r,org-columns-redo}
5214 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
5215 @orgcmd{g,org-columns-redo}
5217 @orgcmd{q,org-columns-quit}
5219 @tsubheading{Editing values}
5220 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
5221 Move through the column view from field to field.
5222 @kindex S-@key{left}
5223 @kindex S-@key{right}
5224 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
5225 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
5226 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
5228 Directly select the Nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
5229 @orgcmdkkcc{n,p,org-columns-next-allowed-value,org-columns-previous-allowed-value}
5230 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
5231 @orgcmd{e,org-columns-edit-value}
5232 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
5233 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
5234 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
5235 or fast selection interface will pop up.
5236 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle}
5237 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
5238 @orgcmd{v,org-columns-show-value}
5239 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
5240 the column is smaller than that of the value.
5241 @orgcmd{a,org-columns-edit-allowed}
5242 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
5243 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
5244 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
5245 current column view.
5246 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
5247 @orgcmdkkcc{<,>,org-columns-narrow,org-columns-widen}
5248 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
5249 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{right},org-columns-new}
5250 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
5251 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{left},org-columns-delete}
5252 Delete the current column.
5255 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
5256 @subsection Capturing column view
5258 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
5259 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
5260 a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
5261 of this block looks like this:
5263 @cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
5266 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
5271 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
5275 This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
5276 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
5277 at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
5278 capture, you can use 4 values:
5279 @cindex property, ID
5281 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
5282 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
5283 "file:@var{path-to-file}"
5284 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
5285 "@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
5286 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
5287 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
5288 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
5291 When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
5292 an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
5294 When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
5296 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
5297 @item :skip-empty-rows
5298 When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
5299 column view is @code{ITEM}.
5304 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
5307 @orgcmd{C-c C-x i,org-insert-columns-dblock}
5308 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
5309 for the scope or ID of the view.
5310 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5311 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5312 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5313 @orgcmd{C-u C-c C-x C-u,org-update-all-dblocks}
5314 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5315 you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing blocks or other dynamic
5319 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
5320 instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
5321 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
5322 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
5324 An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
5325 provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
5326 package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
5327 distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
5328 @uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
5329 properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
5330 process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
5332 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
5333 @section The Property API
5334 @cindex properties, API
5335 @cindex API, for properties
5337 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
5338 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
5339 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
5342 @node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
5343 @chapter Dates and times
5349 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
5350 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
5351 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org mode. This may be a
5352 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
5353 something was created or last changed. However, in Org mode this term
5354 is used in a much wider sense.
5357 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
5358 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
5359 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
5360 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
5361 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
5362 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
5363 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
5367 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
5368 @section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
5370 @cindex ranges, time
5375 A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
5376 times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>}@footnote{In this
5377 simplest form, the day name is optional when you type the date yourself.
5378 However, any dates inserted or modified by Org will add that day name, for
5379 reading convenience.} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16
5380 Tue 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601
5381 date/time format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time
5382 format}.}. A timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org
5383 tree entry. Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the
5384 agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
5387 @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
5390 A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
5391 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
5392 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
5393 plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
5396 * Meet Peter at the movies <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
5397 * Discussion on climate change <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
5400 @item Timestamp with repeater interval
5401 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
5402 A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
5403 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
5404 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
5405 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
5408 * Pick up Sam at school <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
5411 @item Diary-style sexp entries
5412 For more complex date specifications, Org mode supports using the special
5413 sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
5414 package@footnote{When working with the standard diary sexp functions, you
5415 need to be very careful with the order of the arguments. That order depend
5416 evilly on the variable @code{calendar-date-style} (or, for older Emacs
5417 versions, @code{european-calendar-style}). For example, to specify a date
5418 December 12, 2005, the call might look like @code{(diary-date 12 1 2005)} or
5419 @code{(diary-date 1 12 2005)} or @code{(diary-date 2005 12 1)}, depending on
5420 the settings. This has been the source of much confusion. Org mode users
5421 can resort to special versions of these functions like @code{org-date} or
5422 @code{org-anniversary}. These work just like the corresponding @code{diary-}
5423 functions, but with stable ISO order of arguments (year, month, day) wherever
5424 applicable, independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.}. For
5425 example with optional time
5428 * 22:00-23:00 The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
5429 <%%(org-float t 4 2)>
5432 @item Time/Date range
5435 Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
5436 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
5437 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
5440 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
5441 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
5444 @item Inactive timestamp
5445 @cindex timestamp, inactive
5446 @cindex inactive timestamp
5447 Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
5448 angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
5449 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
5452 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time [2006-11-01 Wed]
5457 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
5458 @section Creating timestamps
5459 @cindex creating timestamps
5460 @cindex timestamps, creating
5462 For Org mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
5463 format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
5467 @orgcmd{C-c .,org-time-stamp}
5468 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
5469 at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
5470 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
5471 succession, a time range is inserted.
5473 @orgcmd{C-c !,org-time-stamp-inactive}
5474 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
5481 @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
5482 Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
5483 contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
5484 minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
5487 Normalize timestamp, insert/fix day name if missing or wrong.
5489 @orgcmd{C-c <,org-date-from-calendar}
5490 Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
5492 @orgcmd{C-c >,org-goto-calendar}
5493 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
5494 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
5497 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
5498 Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
5499 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
5501 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-timestamp-down-day,org-timestamp-up-day}
5502 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
5503 shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5505 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-timestamp-up,org-timestamp-down-down}
5506 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
5507 year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
5508 like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
5509 shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
5510 the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
5511 timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
5512 (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
5513 related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5515 @orgcmd{C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5516 @cindex evaluate time range
5517 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
5518 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
5519 the following column).
5524 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
5525 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
5528 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
5529 @subsection The date/time prompt
5530 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
5531 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
5533 @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
5534 When Org mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
5535 date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
5536 format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or
5537 time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
5538 can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
5539 copied from an email message. Org mode will find whatever information is in
5540 there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
5541 and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
5542 modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
5543 range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
5544 information, Org mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
5545 date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
5546 @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
5547 variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
5548 the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
5549 tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
5550 time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
5552 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
5553 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org mode are
5557 3-2-5 @result{} 2003-02-05
5558 2/5/3 @result{} 2003-02-05
5559 14 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
5560 12 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
5561 2/5 @result{} @b{2007}-02-05
5562 Fri @result{} nearest Friday (default date or later)
5563 sep 15 @result{} @b{2006}-09-15
5564 feb 15 @result{} @b{2007}-02-15
5565 sep 12 9 @result{} 2009-09-12
5566 12:45 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
5567 22 sept 0:34 @result{} @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
5568 w4 @result{} ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
5569 2012 w4 fri @result{} Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
5570 2012-w04-5 @result{} Same as above
5573 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
5574 @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
5575 letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
5576 single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
5577 double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
5578 a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
5579 the Nth such day, e.g.@:
5584 +4d @result{} four days from today
5585 +4 @result{} same as above
5586 +2w @result{} two weeks from today
5587 ++5 @result{} five days from default date
5588 +2tue @result{} second Tuesday from now.
5591 @vindex parse-time-months
5592 @vindex parse-time-weekdays
5593 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
5594 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
5595 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
5597 @vindex org-read-date-force-compatible-dates
5598 Not all dates can be represented in a given Emacs implementation. By default
5599 Org mode forces dates into the compatibility range 1970--2037 which works on
5600 all Emacs implementations. If you want to use dates outside of this range,
5601 read the docstring of the variable
5602 @code{org-read-date-force-compatible-dates}.
5604 You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by giving a
5605 start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use one or two dash(es) as the
5606 separator in the former case and use '+' as the separator in the latter
5610 11am-1:15pm @result{} 11:00-13:15
5611 11am--1:15pm @result{} same as above
5612 11am+2:15 @result{} same as above
5615 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
5616 @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
5617 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
5618 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
5619 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
5620 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
5621 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
5622 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
5623 from the minibuffer:
5630 @kindex S-@key{right}
5631 @kindex S-@key{left}
5632 @kindex S-@key{down}
5634 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
5635 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
5638 @key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
5639 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
5640 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
5641 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
5642 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
5643 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
5644 M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
5647 @vindex org-read-date-display-live
5648 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
5649 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
5650 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
5651 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
5652 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
5653 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
5655 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
5656 @subsection Custom time format
5657 @cindex custom date/time format
5658 @cindex time format, custom
5659 @cindex date format, custom
5661 @vindex org-display-custom-times
5662 @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
5663 Org mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
5664 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
5665 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
5666 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
5667 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
5670 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-t,org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays}
5671 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
5675 Org mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
5676 format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
5677 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
5678 following consequences:
5681 You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
5684 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
5685 each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
5686 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
5687 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
5688 time will be changed by one minute.
5690 If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
5691 will not be overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were.
5693 When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
5694 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
5695 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
5697 If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
5698 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
5699 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
5703 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
5704 @section Deadlines and scheduling
5706 A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
5710 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
5712 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
5713 to be finished on that date.
5715 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5716 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
5717 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
5718 approaching or missed deadline, starting
5719 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
5720 until the entry is marked DONE. An example:
5723 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
5724 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
5725 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
5728 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
5729 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
5730 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
5733 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
5735 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
5738 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
5739 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
5740 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE. If you don't like
5741 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
5742 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
5743 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE, i.e.@:
5744 the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
5747 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
5748 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
5752 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org mode should @i{not} be
5753 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
5754 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
5755 mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
5756 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
5757 Org users. In Org mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
5758 want to start working on an action item.
5761 You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
5762 entries. Org mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
5763 assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
5764 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
5766 @code{<%%(org-float t 42)>}
5768 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org mode does not
5769 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
5770 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
5774 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
5775 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
5778 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
5779 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
5781 The following commands allow you to quickly insert@footnote{The @samp{SCHEDULED} and
5782 @samp{DEADLINE} dates are inserted on the line right below the headline. Don't put
5783 any text between this line and the headline.} a deadline or to schedule
5788 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-deadline}
5789 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
5790 in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp will be
5791 removed. When called with a prefix arg, an existing deadline will be removed
5792 from the entry. Depending on the variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
5793 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
5794 and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5797 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-schedule}
5798 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
5799 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
5800 will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
5801 date from the entry. Depending on the variable
5802 @code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
5803 keywords @code{logreschedule}, @code{lognotereschedule}, and
5804 @code{nologreschedule}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5807 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-k,org-mark-entry-for-agenda-action}
5810 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
5811 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
5812 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
5813 schedule the marked item.
5815 @orgcmd{C-c / d,org-check-deadlines}
5816 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
5817 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5818 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
5819 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
5820 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
5821 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
5822 all deadlines due tomorrow.
5824 @orgcmd{C-c / b,org-check-before-date}
5825 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
5827 @orgcmd{C-c / a,org-check-after-date}
5828 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
5831 Note that @code{org-schedule} and @code{org-deadline} supports
5832 setting the date by indicating a relative time: e.g. +1d will set
5833 the date to the next day after today, and --1w will set the date
5834 to the previous week before any current timestamp.
5836 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
5837 @subsection Repeated tasks
5838 @cindex tasks, repeated
5839 @cindex repeated tasks
5841 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org mode helps to
5842 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
5843 or plain timestamp. In the following example
5845 ** TODO Pay the rent
5846 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
5849 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
5850 has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
5851 from that time. If you need both a repeater and a special warning period in
5852 a deadline entry, the repeater should come first and the warning period last:
5853 @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
5855 @vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
5856 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
5857 over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
5858 once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
5859 keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
5860 with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
5861 repeated entry will not be active. Org mode deals with this in the following
5862 way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
5863 shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
5864 immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
5865 state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
5866 the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
5867 specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
5868 sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
5869 switch the date like this:
5872 ** TODO Pay the rent
5873 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
5876 @vindex org-log-repeat
5877 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
5878 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
5879 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
5880 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
5881 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
5883 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
5884 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
5887 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
5888 month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
5889 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
5890 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
5891 forgot to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
5892 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
5893 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
5894 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org mode has
5895 special repeaters @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
5899 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
5900 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
5901 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
5902 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
5903 and marked it done on Saturday.
5904 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
5905 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
5906 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
5910 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
5911 task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
5913 An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
5914 subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
5915 created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
5918 @node Clocking work time, Effort estimates, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
5919 @section Clocking work time
5920 @cindex clocking time
5921 @cindex time clocking
5923 Org mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
5924 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock. When
5925 you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the clock is
5926 stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It also computes
5927 the total time spent on each subtree@footnote{Clocking only works if all
5928 headings are indented with less than 30 stars. This is a hardcoded
5929 limitation of `lmax' in `org-clock-sum'.} of a project. And it remembers a
5930 history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly between a
5931 number of tasks absorbing your time.
5933 To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
5935 (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
5936 (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
5938 When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
5939 clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
5940 on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
5941 will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
5945 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
5946 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
5947 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
5950 @node Clocking commands, The clock table, Clocking work time, Clocking work time
5951 @subsection Clocking commands
5954 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-i,org-clock-in}
5955 @vindex org-clock-into-drawer
5956 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
5957 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
5958 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
5959 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
5960 @code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
5961 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). You can also overrule
5962 the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
5963 @code{CLOCK_INTO_DRAWER} or @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
5964 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
5965 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
5966 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task.
5967 The default task will always be available when selecting a clocking task,
5968 with letter @kbd{d}.@*
5969 @cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
5970 @cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
5971 @vindex org-clock-modeline-total
5972 While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
5973 line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
5974 time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
5975 estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
5976 clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
5977 hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
5978 is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
5979 reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
5980 will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
5981 the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
5982 @code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
5983 show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
5984 @code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
5985 @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
5986 @code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
5987 mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
5989 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-o,org-clock-out}
5990 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
5991 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
5992 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
5993 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
5994 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
5995 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
5996 timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
5997 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
5998 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
5999 Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
6002 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
6003 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
6004 is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
6005 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
6006 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{up/down},org-clock-timestamps-up/down}
6007 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease both timestamps at the same
6008 time so that duration keeps the same.
6009 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
6010 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
6011 if it is running in this same item.
6012 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-x,org-clock-cancel}
6013 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
6014 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
6015 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-j,org-clock-goto}
6016 Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a @kbd{C-u}
6017 prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked tasks.
6018 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-d,org-clock-display}
6019 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
6020 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This puts
6021 overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time recorded under
6022 that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You can use visibility
6023 cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear when you change the
6024 buffer (see variable @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press
6028 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
6029 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
6030 worked on or closed during a day.
6032 @node The clock table, Resolving idle time, Clocking commands, Clocking work time
6033 @subsection The clock table
6034 @cindex clocktable, dynamic block
6035 @cindex report, of clocked time
6037 Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking
6038 information. Such a report is called a @emph{clock table}, because it is
6039 formatted as one or several Org tables.
6042 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-r,org-clock-report}
6043 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
6044 report as an Org mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
6045 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
6046 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
6047 update it. The clock table always includes also trees with
6048 @code{:ARCHIVE:} tag.
6049 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
6050 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
6051 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
6052 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
6053 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
6054 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
6055 @orgcmdkxkc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-clocktable-try-shift}
6056 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
6057 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
6058 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
6062 Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted into the
6063 buffer with the @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} command:
6065 @cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
6067 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
6071 @vindex org-clocktable-defaults
6072 The @samp{BEGIN} line and specify a number of options to define the scope,
6073 structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these options can
6074 be configured in the variable @code{org-clocktable-defaults}.
6076 @noindent First there are options that determine which clock entries are to
6079 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
6080 @r{Clocks at deeper levels will be summed into the upper level.}
6081 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
6082 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
6083 file @r{the full current buffer}
6084 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
6085 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
6086 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
6087 agenda @r{all agenda files}
6088 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
6089 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
6090 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
6091 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
6092 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
6094 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
6095 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
6096 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
6097 2007-Q2 @r{2nd quarter in 2007}
6098 2007 @r{the year 2007}
6099 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
6100 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
6101 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
6102 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
6103 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
6104 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
6105 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
6106 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
6107 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
6108 :stepskip0 @r{Do not show steps that have zero time.}
6109 :fileskip0 @r{Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute.}
6110 :tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute. See}
6111 @r{@ref{Matching tags and properties} for the match syntax.}
6114 Then there are options which determine the formatting of the table. There
6115 options are interpreted by the function @code{org-clocktable-write-default},
6116 but you can specify your own function using the @code{:formatter} parameter.
6118 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
6119 :lang @r{Language@footnote{Language terms can be set through the variable @code{org-clock-clocktable-language-setup}.} to use for descriptive cells like "Task".}
6120 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
6121 :narrow @r{An integer to limit the width of the headline column in}
6122 @r{the org table. If you write it like @samp{50!}, then the}
6123 @r{headline will also be shortened in export.}
6124 :indent @r{Indent each headline field according to its level.}
6125 :tcolumns @r{Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller}
6126 @r{than @code{:maxlevel}, lower levels will be lumped into one column.}
6127 :level @r{Should a level number column be included?}
6128 :compact @r{Abbreviation for @code{:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1}}
6129 @r{All are overwritten except if there is an explicit @code{:narrow}}
6130 :timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
6131 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
6132 :properties @r{List of properties that should be shown in the table. Each}
6133 @r{property will get its own column.}
6134 :inherit-props @r{When this flag is @code{t}, the values for @code{:properties} will be inherited.}
6135 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
6136 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
6137 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula}
6138 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
6139 :formatter @r{A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer.}
6141 To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
6142 day, you could write
6144 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
6148 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
6149 parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
6150 only to fit it into the manual.}
6152 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
6153 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
6156 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
6158 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
6161 A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during last week
6164 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t
6168 @node Resolving idle time, , The clock table, Clocking work time
6169 @subsection Resolving idle time
6170 @cindex resolve idle time
6172 @cindex idle, resolve, dangling
6173 If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
6174 computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
6175 time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
6176 applying it to another one.
6178 @vindex org-clock-idle-time
6179 By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
6180 as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
6181 being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
6182 idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
6183 X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
6184 UTILITIES directory of the Org git distribution, to get the same general
6185 treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs idle time
6186 only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will be a
6187 question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle time has
6188 passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a set of
6189 choices to correct the discrepancy:
6193 To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
6194 will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
6195 effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
6197 If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
6198 you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
6199 the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
6201 To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
6202 the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
6204 To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
6205 use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
6206 leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
6208 To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
6209 canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
6210 than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
6211 log with an empty entry.
6214 What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
6215 want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
6216 after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
6217 the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
6218 the next task you clock in on.
6220 There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
6221 were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
6222 scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
6223 lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
6224 mode changes, including your last clock in.
6226 If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
6227 dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
6228 that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
6229 Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
6230 identical to dealing with away time due to idleness; it is just happening due
6231 to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
6233 You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
6234 clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks}.
6236 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
6237 @section Effort estimates
6238 @cindex effort estimates
6240 @cindex property, Effort
6241 @vindex org-effort-property
6242 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
6243 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
6244 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
6245 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
6246 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
6247 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
6248 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
6249 for an entry with the following commands:
6252 @orgcmd{C-c C-x e,org-set-effort}
6253 Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
6254 argument, set it to the Nth allowed value (see below). This command is also
6255 accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
6256 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6257 Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
6260 Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
6261 (@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
6262 effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
6263 together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
6267 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00
6268 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
6272 @vindex org-global-properties
6273 @vindex org-columns-default-format
6274 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
6275 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
6276 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
6277 setup may be advised.
6279 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
6280 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
6281 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
6282 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
6284 @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
6285 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
6286 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
6287 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
6288 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
6289 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
6290 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
6291 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
6292 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
6294 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
6295 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
6296 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
6297 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
6299 @node Relative timer, Countdown timer, Effort estimates, Dates and Times
6300 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
6301 @cindex relative timer
6303 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
6304 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
6305 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
6308 @orgcmd{C-c C-x .,org-timer}
6309 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
6310 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
6312 @orgcmd{C-c C-x -,org-timer-item}
6313 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
6314 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
6315 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
6316 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
6318 @c for key sequences with a comma, command name macros fail :(
6321 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused
6322 (@command{org-timer-pause-or-continue}).
6323 @c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
6324 @kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
6326 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
6327 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
6328 @orgcmd{C-c C-x 0,org-timer-start}
6329 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
6330 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
6331 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
6332 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
6333 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
6334 prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
6335 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
6336 not started at exactly the right moment.
6339 @node Countdown timer, , Relative timer, Dates and Times
6340 @section Countdown timer
6341 @cindex Countdown timer
6345 Calling @code{org-timer-set-timer} from an Org mode buffer runs a countdown
6346 timer. Use @kbd{;} from agenda buffers, @key{C-c C-x ;} everywhere else.
6348 @code{org-timer-set-timer} prompts the user for a duration and displays a
6349 countdown timer in the modeline. @code{org-timer-default-timer} sets the
6350 default countdown value. Giving a prefix numeric argument overrides this
6353 @node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
6354 @chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
6357 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
6358 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
6359 Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
6360 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
6361 system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
6362 trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
6365 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
6366 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
6367 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
6368 * Protocols:: External (e.g.@: Browser) access to Emacs and Org
6369 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
6370 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
6373 @node Capture, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
6377 Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley
6378 excellent remember package. Up to version 6.36 Org used a special setup
6379 for @file{remember.el}. @file{org-remember.el} is still part of Org mode for
6380 backward compatibility with existing setups. You can find the documentation
6381 for org-remember at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-remember.pdf}.
6383 The new capturing setup described here is preferred and should be used by new
6384 users. To convert your @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
6386 @kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates @key{RET}}
6388 @noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
6389 customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
6390 customization. You can then use both remember and capture until
6391 you are familiar with the new mechanism.
6393 Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
6394 flow. The basic process of capturing is very similar to remember, but Org
6395 does enhance it with templates and more.
6398 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
6399 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
6400 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
6403 @node Setting up capture, Using capture, Capture, Capture
6404 @subsection Setting up capture
6406 The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
6407 a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
6408 suggestion.} for capturing new material.
6410 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6412 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
6413 (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
6416 @node Using capture, Capture templates, Setting up capture, Capture
6417 @subsection Using capture
6420 @orgcmd{C-c c,org-capture}
6421 Call the command @code{org-capture}. Note that this keybinding is global and
6422 not active by default - you need to install it. If you have templates
6424 defined @pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for
6425 selection or use a new Org outline node as the default template. It will
6426 insert the template into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer
6427 narrowed to this new node. You may then insert the information you want.
6429 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-capture-finalize}
6430 Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer, @kbd{C-c
6431 C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture process,
6432 so that you can resume your work without further distraction. When called
6433 with a prefix arg, finalize and then jump to the captured item.
6435 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-capture-refile}
6436 Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refiling notes}) the note to
6437 a different place. Please realize that this is a normal refiling command
6438 that will be executed---so the cursor position at the moment you run this
6439 command is important. If you have inserted a tree with a parent and
6440 children, first move the cursor back to the parent. Any prefix argument
6441 given to this command will be passed on to the @code{org-refile} command.
6443 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,org-capture-kill}
6444 Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
6448 You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
6449 the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
6450 the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
6451 rather than to the current date.
6453 To find the locations of the last stored capture, use @code{org-capture} with
6458 Visit the target location of a capture template. You get to select the
6459 template in the usual way.
6460 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-c c}
6461 Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer.
6464 @node Capture templates, , Using capture, Capture
6465 @subsection Capture templates
6466 @cindex templates, for Capture
6468 You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
6469 for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
6470 through the customize interface.
6474 Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
6477 Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
6478 an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
6479 entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
6480 your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
6481 @file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
6485 (setq org-capture-templates
6486 '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
6487 "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
6488 ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
6489 "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
6492 @noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
6496 [[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
6500 During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
6501 the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
6502 extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
6503 the task definition, press @code{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
6504 place where you started the capture process.
6506 To define special keys to capture to a particular template without going
6507 through the interactive template selection, you can create your key binding
6511 (define-key global-map "\C-cx"
6512 (lambda () (interactive) (org-capture nil "x")))
6516 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
6517 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
6520 @node Template elements, Template expansion, Capture templates, Capture templates
6521 @subsubsection Template elements
6523 Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
6524 @code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
6528 The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
6529 only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
6530 single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
6531 several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
6532 in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
6533 prefix key, for example
6535 ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
6537 @noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
6538 be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
6541 A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
6545 The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
6548 An Org mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the target
6549 entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org mode file.
6551 A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
6552 location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
6554 A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
6557 a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
6558 line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
6559 @code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
6561 Text to be inserted as it is.
6565 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6566 Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org mode
6567 files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this
6568 node. Other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this
6569 node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is
6570 the empty string, it defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}. A file can
6571 also be given as a variable, function, or Emacs Lisp form.
6575 @item (file "path/to/file")
6576 Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
6578 @item (id "id of existing org entry")
6579 Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
6581 @item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
6582 Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
6584 @item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
6585 For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
6587 @item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
6588 Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
6590 @item (file+datetree "path/to/file")
6591 Will create a heading in a date tree for today's date.
6593 @item (file+datetree+prompt "path/to/file")
6594 Will create a heading in a date tree, but will prompt for the date.
6596 @item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
6597 A function to find the right location in the file.
6600 File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
6602 @item (function function-finding-location)
6603 Most general way, write your own function to find both
6608 The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
6609 appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
6610 escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
6611 capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
6612 using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
6616 The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
6617 Recognized properties are:
6620 Normally new captured information will be appended at
6621 the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
6622 Setting this property will change that.
6624 @item :immediate-finish
6625 When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
6626 file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
6627 information that can be added automatically.
6630 Set this to the number of lines to insert
6631 before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
6634 Start the clock in this item.
6637 Keep the clock running when filing the captured entry.
6640 If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
6641 with the capture. Note that @code{:clock-keep} has precedence over
6642 @code{:clock-resume}. When setting both to @code{t}, the current clock will
6643 run and the previous one will not be resumed.
6646 Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
6647 narrow it so that you only see the new material.
6649 @item :table-line-pos
6650 Specification of the location in the table where the new line should be
6651 inserted. It should be a string like @code{"II-3"} meaning that the new
6652 line should become the third line before the second horizontal separator
6656 If the target file was not yet visited when capture was invoked, kill the
6657 buffer again after capture is completed.
6661 @node Template expansion, , Template elements, Capture templates
6662 @subsubsection Template expansion
6664 In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
6665 these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
6666 dynamic insertion of content. The templates are expanded in the order given here:
6669 %[@var{file}] @r{insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}.}
6670 %(@var{sexp}) @r{evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result.}
6671 %<...> @r{the result of format-time-string on the ... format specification.}
6672 %t @r{timestamp, date only.}
6673 %T @r{timestamp with date and time.}
6674 %u, %U @r{like the above, but inactive timestamps.}
6675 %a @r{annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}.}
6676 %i @r{initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
6677 @r{region is active.}
6678 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
6679 %A @r{like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part.}
6680 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
6681 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
6682 %k @r{title of the currently clocked task.}
6683 %K @r{link to the currently clocked task.}
6684 %n @r{user name (taken from @code{user-full-name}).}
6685 %f @r{file visited by current buffer when org-capture was called.}
6686 %F @r{full path of the file or directory visited by current buffer.}
6687 %:keyword @r{specific information for certain link types, see below.}
6688 %^g @r{prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
6689 %^G @r{prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
6690 %^t @r{like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}.}
6691 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}.}
6692 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
6693 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
6694 %^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}.}
6695 %^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
6696 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
6697 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}.}
6698 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
6702 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
6703 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
6704 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
6705 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
6708 @vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
6710 Link type | Available keywords
6711 ---------------------------------+----------------------------------------------
6712 bbdb | %:name %:company
6713 irc | %:server %:port %:nick
6714 vm, vm-imap, wl, mh, mew, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
6715 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
6716 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
6717 | %:date @r{(message date header field)}
6718 | %:date-timestamp @r{(date as active timestamp)}
6719 | %:date-timestamp-inactive @r{(date as inactive timestamp)}
6720 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
6721 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
6723 info | %:file %:node
6728 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
6731 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6735 @node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Capture, Capture - Refile - Archive
6736 @section Attachments
6739 @vindex org-attach-directory
6740 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
6741 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
6742 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
6743 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
6744 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
6745 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
6746 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
6747 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
6748 your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
6749 directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
6750 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
6751 @code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
6752 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
6754 In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
6755 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
6756 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
6759 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
6763 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
6764 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
6765 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
6766 to select a command:
6769 @orgcmdtkc{a,C-c C-a a,org-attach-attach}
6770 @vindex org-attach-method
6771 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
6772 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
6773 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6779 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
6780 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6782 @orgcmdtkc{n,C-c C-a n,org-attach-new}
6783 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
6785 @orgcmdtkc{z,C-c C-a z,org-attach-sync}
6786 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
6787 attachments yourself.
6789 @orgcmdtkc{o,C-c C-a o,org-attach-open}
6790 @vindex org-file-apps
6791 Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
6792 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
6793 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
6794 (@pxref{Handling links}).
6796 @orgcmdtkc{O,C-c C-a O,org-attach-open-in-emacs}
6797 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
6799 @orgcmdtkc{f,C-c C-a f,org-attach-reveal}
6800 Open the current task's attachment directory.
6802 @orgcmdtkc{F,C-c C-a F,org-attach-reveal-in-emacs}
6803 Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
6805 @orgcmdtkc{d,C-c C-a d,org-attach-delete-one}
6806 Select and delete a single attachment.
6808 @orgcmdtkc{D,C-c C-a D,org-attach-delete-all}
6809 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
6810 @command{dired} and delete from there.
6812 @orgcmdtkc{s,C-c C-a s,org-attach-set-directory}
6813 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
6814 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
6815 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
6817 @orgcmdtkc{i,C-c C-a i,org-attach-set-inherit}
6818 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
6819 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
6820 same directory for attachments as the parent does.
6824 @node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
6829 Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
6830 Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
6831 podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
6832 web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
6833 @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
6834 information. Here is just an example:
6837 (setq org-feed-alist
6839 "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
6840 "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
6844 will configure that new items from the feed provided by
6845 @code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
6846 @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
6847 the following command is used:
6850 @orgcmd{C-c C-x g,org-feed-update-all}
6852 Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
6854 @orgcmd{C-c C-x G,org-feed-goto-inbox}
6855 Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
6858 Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
6859 it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
6860 adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
6861 list of drawers in that file:
6864 #+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
6867 For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
6868 @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
6870 @node Protocols, Refiling notes, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
6871 @section Protocols for external access
6872 @cindex protocols, for external access
6875 You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
6876 are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
6877 configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
6878 Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
6879 could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
6880 a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
6881 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
6882 documentation and setup instructions.
6884 @node Refiling notes, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
6885 @section Refiling notes
6886 @cindex refiling notes
6888 When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the entries
6889 into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the
6890 right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this
6891 process, you can use the following special command:
6894 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
6895 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
6896 @vindex org-refile-targets
6897 @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
6898 @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
6899 @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
6900 @vindex org-log-refile
6901 @vindex org-refile-use-cache
6902 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
6903 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
6904 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
6905 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
6907 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
6908 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
6909 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
6910 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
6911 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
6912 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
6913 create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
6914 variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
6915 When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
6916 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
6917 and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a timestamp or a note will be
6918 recorded when an entry has been refiled.
6919 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-w}
6920 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
6921 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-w,org-refile-goto-last-stored}
6922 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
6924 Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
6925 @orgcmdtkc{C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w,C-0 C-c C-w,org-refile-cache-clear}
6926 Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
6927 setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command see new possible
6928 targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
6931 @node Archiving, , Refiling notes, Capture - Refile - Archive
6935 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
6936 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
6937 agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
6938 searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
6941 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-a,org-archive-subtree-default}
6942 @vindex org-archive-default-command
6943 Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
6944 @code{org-archive-default-command}.
6948 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
6949 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
6952 @node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
6953 @subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
6954 @cindex external archiving
6956 The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
6960 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,C-c $,org-archive-subtree}
6961 @vindex org-archive-location
6962 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
6963 given by @code{org-archive-location}.
6964 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-s}
6965 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
6966 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
6967 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
6968 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
6969 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
6972 @cindex archive locations
6973 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
6974 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
6975 current file name. For information and examples on how to change this,
6976 see the documentation string of the variable
6977 @code{org-archive-location}. There is also an in-buffer option for
6978 setting this variable, for example@footnote{For backward compatibility,
6979 the following also works: If there are several such lines in a file,
6980 each specifies the archive location for the text below it. The first
6981 such line also applies to any text before its definition. However,
6982 using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible
6983 with the outline structure of the document. The correct method for
6984 setting multiple archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
6988 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
6991 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
6993 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
6994 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
6995 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
6997 @vindex org-archive-save-context-info
6998 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
6999 record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
7000 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
7001 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
7005 @node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
7006 @subsection Internal archiving
7008 If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
7009 moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
7011 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
7012 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
7015 @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
7016 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
7017 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
7018 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
7019 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
7020 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
7022 @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
7023 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
7024 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
7025 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
7027 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
7028 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
7029 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
7030 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
7031 be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
7032 temporarily included.
7034 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
7035 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
7036 is. Configure the details using the variable
7037 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
7039 @vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
7040 Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
7041 @code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
7044 The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
7047 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-toggle-archive-tag}
7048 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
7049 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
7051 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x a}
7052 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
7053 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
7054 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
7055 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
7056 level 1 trees will be checked.
7057 @orgcmd{C-@kbd{TAB},org-force-cycle-archived}
7058 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
7059 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-archive-to-archive-sibling}
7060 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
7061 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
7062 entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
7063 original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
7068 @node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
7069 @chapter Agenda views
7070 @cindex agenda views
7072 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
7073 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
7074 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
7075 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
7076 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
7078 Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
7079 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
7083 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
7086 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
7089 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
7090 TODO state associated with them,
7092 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
7093 in time-sorted view,
7095 a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
7096 that contain specified keywords,
7098 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
7101 @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
7106 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
7107 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
7108 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
7109 edit these files remotely.
7111 @vindex org-agenda-window-setup
7112 @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
7113 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
7114 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
7115 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
7116 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
7119 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
7120 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
7121 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
7122 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
7123 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
7124 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
7125 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
7126 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
7129 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
7130 @section Agenda files
7131 @cindex agenda files
7132 @cindex files for agenda
7134 @vindex org-agenda-files
7135 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
7136 files}, the files listed in the variable
7137 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
7138 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
7139 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
7140 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
7143 Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
7144 be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
7145 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
7146 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
7147 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
7148 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
7150 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
7152 @orgcmd{C-c [,org-agenda-file-to-front}
7153 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
7154 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
7155 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
7156 @orgcmd{C-c ],org-remove-file}
7157 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
7159 @cindex cycling, of agenda files
7160 @orgcmd{C-',org-cycle-agenda-files}
7162 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
7163 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
7164 @item M-x org-iswitchb
7165 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
7170 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
7171 to visit any of them.
7173 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
7174 this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
7175 file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
7176 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
7177 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
7178 extended period, use the following commands:
7181 @orgcmd{C-c C-x <,org-agenda-set-restriction-lock}
7182 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
7183 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
7184 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
7185 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
7186 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
7187 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
7188 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7189 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
7193 When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
7196 @orgcmdtkc{< @r{in the speedbar frame},<,org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction}
7197 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
7198 in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
7199 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
7201 @orgcmdtkc{> @r{in the speedbar frame},>,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7202 Lift the restriction.
7205 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
7206 @section The agenda dispatcher
7207 @cindex agenda dispatcher
7208 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
7209 The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
7210 global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Activation}). In the
7211 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
7212 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
7213 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
7214 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
7217 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
7219 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
7221 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
7222 tags and properties}).
7224 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
7226 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
7227 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
7229 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7230 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
7231 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
7232 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
7233 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
7236 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
7238 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
7239 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
7240 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
7241 selecting the command.
7243 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
7244 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
7245 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
7246 current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
7247 character selecting the command.
7250 @vindex org-agenda-sticky
7251 Toggle sticky agenda views. By default, Org maintains only a single agenda
7252 buffer and rebuilds it each time you change the view, to make sure everything
7253 is always up to date. If you switch between views often and the build time
7254 bothers you, you can turn on sticky agenda buffers (make this the default by
7255 customizing the variable @code{org-agenda-sticky}). With sticky agendas, the
7256 dispatcher only switches to the selected view, you need to update it by hand
7257 with @kbd{r} or @kbd{g}.
7260 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
7261 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
7262 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
7263 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
7264 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
7266 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
7267 @section The built-in agenda views
7269 In this section we describe the built-in views.
7272 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
7273 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
7274 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
7275 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
7276 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
7277 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
7280 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
7281 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
7283 @cindex weekly agenda
7284 @cindex daily agenda
7286 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
7287 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
7290 @cindex org-agenda, command
7291 @orgcmd{C-c a a,org-agenda-list}
7292 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
7293 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
7294 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
7295 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
7296 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
7297 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed.
7300 @vindex org-agenda-span
7301 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
7302 The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the variable
7303 @code{org-agenda-span} (or the obsolete @code{org-agenda-ndays}). This
7304 variable can be set to any number of days you want to see by default in the
7305 agenda, or to a span name, such a @code{day}, @code{week}, @code{month} or
7308 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
7309 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
7310 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
7313 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
7314 @cindex calendar integration
7315 @cindex diary integration
7317 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
7318 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
7319 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
7320 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
7321 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
7322 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
7325 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org mode's
7326 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
7329 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
7332 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
7333 entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
7334 agenda buffer created by Org mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
7335 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
7336 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
7337 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
7338 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
7339 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
7340 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
7341 between calendar and agenda.
7343 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
7344 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
7345 the entries into an Org file. Org mode evaluates diary-style sexp
7346 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
7347 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
7348 the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
7349 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
7350 will be made in the agenda:
7353 * Birthdays and similar stuff
7355 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
7357 %%(org-anniversary 1956 5 14)@footnote{@code{org-anniversary} is just like @code{diary-anniversary}, but the argument order is always according to ISO and therefore independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
7358 %%(org-anniversary 1869 10 2) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
7361 @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
7362 @cindex BBDB, anniversaries
7363 @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
7365 If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
7366 very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
7367 separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
7368 anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
7369 following to one of your agenda files:
7376 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
7379 You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
7380 you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
7381 record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD} or @code{MM-DD},
7382 followed by a space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or
7383 @samp{wedding}, or a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to
7384 @samp{birthday}. Here are a few examples, the header for the file
7385 @file{org-bbdb.el} contains more detailed information.
7391 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org mode, %d years ago
7394 After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
7395 session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
7396 hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
7397 faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
7398 in an Org or Diary file.
7400 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
7401 @cindex @file{appt.el}
7402 @cindex appointment reminders
7406 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add all
7407 the appointments of your agenda files, use the command
7408 @code{org-agenda-to-appt}. This command also lets you filter through the
7409 list of your appointments and add only those belonging to a specific category
7410 or matching a regular expression. See the docstring for details.
7412 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
7413 @subsection The global TODO list
7414 @cindex global TODO list
7415 @cindex TODO list, global
7417 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
7418 collected into a single place.
7421 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
7422 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
7423 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
7424 items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
7425 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
7426 entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
7427 @orgcmd{C-c a T,org-todo-list}
7428 @cindex TODO keyword matching
7429 @vindex org-todo-keywords
7430 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
7431 also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
7432 prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
7433 separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
7434 prefix, the Nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
7436 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
7437 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
7438 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
7439 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
7440 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
7441 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
7444 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
7445 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
7446 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
7448 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
7449 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
7450 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
7454 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
7455 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
7456 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp
7457 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
7458 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
7459 have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
7460 Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
7461 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines},
7462 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp} and/or
7463 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the global
7466 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
7467 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
7468 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
7469 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
7470 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
7473 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
7474 @subsection Matching tags and properties
7475 @cindex matching, of tags
7476 @cindex matching, of properties
7480 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
7481 or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
7482 based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
7483 syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
7487 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
7488 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
7489 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
7490 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
7491 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
7492 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
7493 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
7494 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
7495 @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
7496 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
7497 not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
7498 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
7499 see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
7500 specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
7504 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
7507 @subsubheading Match syntax
7509 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
7510 A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
7511 OR. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
7512 not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
7513 expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
7514 VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
7515 may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
7516 sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
7517 @samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
7521 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
7524 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
7525 @item work|laptop+night
7526 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
7530 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
7531 Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
7532 braces. For example,
7533 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
7534 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
7536 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
7537 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
7538 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
7539 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
7540 You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
7541 time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
7542 properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
7543 example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
7544 entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
7545 So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
7546 that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
7547 DONE. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
7548 count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
7549 The ITEM special property cannot currently be used in tags/property
7550 searches@footnote{But @pxref{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp,
7551 ,skipping entries based on regexp}.}.
7553 Here are more examples:
7555 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
7556 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
7557 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
7558 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
7559 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
7562 When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
7563 the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
7566 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
7567 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
7571 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
7574 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
7575 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
7576 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
7578 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
7579 a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
7581 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
7582 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
7583 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
7584 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
7585 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
7586 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e.@: without a time
7587 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
7588 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
7589 respectively, can be used.
7591 If the comparison value is enclosed
7592 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
7593 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
7597 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
7598 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
7599 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
7600 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
7601 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
7602 on or after October 11, 2008.
7604 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
7605 other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
7606 price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
7609 You can configure Org mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
7610 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
7611 inheritance}, for details.
7613 For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
7614 different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
7615 tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
7616 connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
7617 expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
7618 tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
7619 several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND.
7620 However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
7621 make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
7622 (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
7623 part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
7624 not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
7628 Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
7629 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
7630 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
7632 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
7633 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
7637 @node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
7638 @subsection Timeline for a single file
7639 @cindex timeline, single file
7640 @cindex time-sorted view
7642 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org mode
7643 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
7644 to give an overview over events in a project.
7647 @orgcmd{C-c a L,org-timeline}
7648 Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
7649 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
7650 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
7654 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
7655 @ref{Agenda commands}.
7657 @node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
7658 @subsection Search view
7661 @cindex searching, for text
7663 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org mode entries.
7664 It is particularly useful to find notes.
7667 @orgcmd{C-c a s,org-search-view}
7668 This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
7669 or specific words using a boolean logic.
7671 For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
7672 that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
7673 separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
7674 Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
7675 logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
7676 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
7677 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
7678 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
7679 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
7680 word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
7681 the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
7683 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7684 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
7685 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
7687 @node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
7688 @subsection Stuck projects
7689 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
7691 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
7692 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
7693 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
7694 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
7695 Org mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
7696 projects and define next actions for them.
7699 @orgcmd{C-c a #,org-agenda-list-stuck-projects}
7700 List projects that are stuck.
7703 @vindex org-stuck-projects
7704 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
7705 project is and how to find it.
7708 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
7709 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
7710 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
7711 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
7713 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org mode, identify
7714 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
7715 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
7716 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
7717 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
7718 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
7719 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
7720 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
7721 with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
7722 @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
7723 IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
7724 correct customization for this is
7727 (setq org-stuck-projects
7728 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
7732 Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
7733 will still be searched for stuck projects.
7735 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
7736 @section Presentation and sorting
7737 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
7739 @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
7740 @vindex org-agenda-tags-column
7741 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org mode visually prepares the
7742 items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line starts
7743 with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category} (@pxref{Categories})
7744 of the item and other important information. You can customize in which
7745 column tags will be displayed through @code{org-agenda-tags-column}. You can
7746 also customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
7747 This prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
7748 associated with the item.
7751 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
7752 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
7753 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
7756 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
7757 @subsection Categories
7761 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
7762 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
7763 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
7764 backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
7765 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
7766 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
7767 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
7768 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
7769 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
7777 @cindex property, CATEGORY
7778 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
7779 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
7780 special category you want to apply as the value.
7783 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
7784 longer than 10 characters.
7787 You can set up icons for category by customizing the
7788 @code{org-agenda-category-icon-alist} variable.
7790 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
7791 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
7792 @cindex time-of-day specification
7794 Org mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
7795 time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
7796 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
7797 ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
7799 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
7801 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
7802 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
7803 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
7804 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
7806 For agenda display, Org mode extracts the time and displays it in a
7807 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
7808 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
7811 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7812 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7813 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7814 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7818 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
7819 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
7822 8:00...... ------------------
7823 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7824 10:00...... ------------------
7825 12:00...... ------------------
7826 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7827 14:00...... ------------------
7828 16:00...... ------------------
7829 18:00...... ------------------
7830 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7831 20:00...... ------------------
7832 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7835 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7836 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7837 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
7838 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
7839 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7841 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
7842 @subsection Sorting of agenda items
7843 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
7844 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
7845 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
7846 done depends on the type of view.
7849 @vindex org-agenda-files
7850 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
7851 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
7852 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
7853 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
7854 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
7855 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
7856 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
7857 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
7858 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
7860 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
7861 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
7862 (@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
7863 priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
7866 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
7867 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
7870 @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
7871 Sorting can be customized using the variable
7872 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
7873 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
7875 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
7876 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
7877 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
7879 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
7880 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
7881 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
7882 original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
7883 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
7884 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
7886 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
7887 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
7890 @tsubheading{Motion}
7891 @cindex motion commands in agenda
7892 @orgcmd{n,org-agenda-next-line}
7893 Next line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
7894 @orgcmd{p,org-agenda-previous-line}
7895 Previous line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
7896 @tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
7897 @orgcmdkkc{@key{SPC},mouse-3,org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up}
7898 Display the original location of the item in another window.
7899 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
7900 outline, not only the heading.
7902 @orgcmd{L,org-agenda-recenter}
7903 Display original location and recenter that window.
7905 @orgcmdkkc{@key{TAB},mouse-2,org-agenda-goto}
7906 Go to the original location of the item in another window.
7908 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-agenda-switch-to}
7909 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
7911 @orgcmd{F,org-agenda-follow-mode}
7912 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
7913 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
7914 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
7915 location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
7916 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7917 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
7919 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
7920 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
7921 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
7922 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
7923 previously used indirect buffer.
7925 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-agenda-open-link}
7926 Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
7927 text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
7928 will be followed without a selection prompt.
7930 @tsubheading{Change display}
7931 @cindex display changing, in agenda
7934 Interactively select another agenda view and append it to the current view.
7938 Delete other windows.
7940 @orgcmdkskc{v d,d,org-agenda-day-view}
7941 @xorgcmdkskc{v w,w,org-agenda-week-view}
7942 @xorgcmd{v m,org-agenda-month-view}
7943 @xorgcmd{v y,org-agenda-year-view}
7944 @xorgcmd{v SPC,org-agenda-reset-view}
7945 @vindex org-agenda-span
7946 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view, this
7947 setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda refreshes. Since month and
7948 year views are slow to create, they do not become the default. A numeric
7949 prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day of the year,
7950 ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example, @kbd{32 d} jumps to
7951 February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When setting day, week, or
7952 month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix argument as well. For
7953 example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in 2007. If such a year
7954 specification has only one or two digits, it will be mapped to the interval
7955 1938-2037. @kbd{v @key{SPC}} will reset to what is set in
7956 @code{org-agenda-span}.
7958 @orgcmd{f,org-agenda-later}
7959 Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
7960 For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
7961 With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
7963 @orgcmd{b,org-agenda-earlier}
7964 Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
7966 @orgcmd{.,org-agenda-goto-today}
7969 @orgcmd{j,org-agenda-goto-date}
7970 Prompt for a date and go there.
7972 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
7973 Go to the currently clocked-in task @i{in the agenda buffer}.
7975 @orgcmd{D,org-agenda-toggle-diary}
7976 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
7978 @orgcmdkskc{v l,l,org-agenda-log-mode}
7980 @vindex org-log-done
7981 @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
7982 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
7983 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
7984 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
7985 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
7986 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
7987 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
7988 prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
7989 @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
7991 @orgcmdkskc{v [,[,org-agenda-manipulate-query-add}
7992 Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
7993 agenda and timeline views.
7995 @orgcmd{v a,org-agenda-archives-mode}
7996 @xorgcmd{v A,org-agenda-archives-mode 'files}
7997 Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
7998 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
7999 capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
8000 press @kbd{v a} again.
8002 @orgcmdkskc{v R,R,org-agenda-clockreport-mode}
8003 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
8004 @vindex org-clock-report-include-clocking-task
8005 Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
8006 always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
8007 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
8008 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8009 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}. By using a prefix argument
8010 when toggling this mode (i.e.@: @kbd{C-u R}), the clock table will not show
8011 contributions from entries that are hidden by agenda filtering@footnote{Only
8012 tags filtering will be respected here, effort filtering is ignored.}. See
8013 also the variable @code{org-clock-report-include-clocking-task}.
8016 @vindex org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks
8017 Show overlapping clock entries, clocking gaps, and other clocking problems in
8018 the current agenda range. You can then visit clocking lines and fix them
8019 manually. See the variable @code{org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks} for
8020 information on how to customize the definition of what constituted a clocking
8021 problem. To return to normal agenda display, press @kbd{l} to exit Logbook
8024 @orgcmdkskc{v E,E,org-agenda-entry-text-mode}
8025 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
8026 @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
8027 Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
8028 outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
8029 The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
8030 @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
8031 prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
8033 @orgcmd{G,org-agenda-toggle-time-grid}
8034 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
8035 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
8036 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
8037 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
8039 @orgcmd{r,org-agenda-redo}
8040 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
8041 modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
8042 @kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
8043 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
8045 @orgcmd{g,org-agenda-redo}
8048 @orgcmdkskc{C-x C-s,s,org-save-all-org-buffers}
8049 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
8052 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8053 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8054 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
8055 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
8056 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
8057 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
8058 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
8059 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
8061 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
8062 Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
8063 file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
8065 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
8066 @cindex filtering, by tag category and effort, in agenda
8067 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
8068 @cindex category filtering, in agenda
8069 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
8070 @cindex query editing, in agenda
8072 @orgcmd{<,org-agenda-filter-by-category}
8073 @vindex org-agenda-category-filter-preset
8075 Filter the current agenda view with respect to the category of the item at
8076 point. Pressing @code{<} another time will remove this filter. You can add
8077 a filter preset through the option @code{org-agenda-category-filter-preset}
8080 @orgcmd{/,org-agenda-filter-by-tag}
8081 @vindex org-agenda-tag-filter-preset
8082 Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
8083 The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
8084 very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
8085 having to recreate the agenda.@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
8086 binding the variable @code{org-agenda-tag-filter-preset} as an option. This
8087 filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
8088 refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of
8089 the entire agenda view---in a block agenda, you should only set this in the
8090 global options section, not in the section of an individual block.}
8092 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter; @key{SPC} will mean any tag at
8093 all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
8094 tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
8095 then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
8096 with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
8097 @kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
8098 If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
8099 will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
8100 Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
8101 immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
8103 @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
8104 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set up allowed
8105 efforts globally, for example
8107 (setq org-global-properties
8108 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
8110 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
8111 @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
8112 estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
8113 The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
8114 or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0-9 are not used
8115 as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
8116 directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
8117 application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
8118 according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
8119 for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
8121 Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
8122 @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
8123 that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
8124 automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
8125 as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
8126 say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
8127 @code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
8128 calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
8129 Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
8133 (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
8135 ((string= tag "Net")
8136 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
8137 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
8138 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
8139 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
8140 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
8143 (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
8147 @orgcmd{\\,org-agenda-filter-by-tag-refine}
8148 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
8149 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
8150 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
8151 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
8160 @item @r{in} search view
8161 add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
8162 (@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
8163 add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
8164 term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
8165 negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
8169 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
8170 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
8175 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
8176 @cindex remote editing, undo
8177 @orgcmd{C-_,org-agenda-undo}
8178 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
8179 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
8181 @orgcmd{t,org-agenda-todo}
8182 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
8185 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{right},org-agenda-todo-nextset}
8186 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{left},org-agenda-todo-previousset}
8187 Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
8189 @orgcmd{C-k,org-agenda-kill}
8190 @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
8191 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
8192 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
8193 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
8194 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
8196 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-agenda-refile}
8197 Refile the entry at point.
8199 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-a,a,org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation}
8200 @vindex org-archive-default-command
8201 Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
8202 archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
8203 @code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
8205 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag}
8206 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
8208 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling}
8209 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
8212 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,$,org-agenda-archive}
8213 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
8214 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
8217 @orgcmd{T,org-agenda-show-tags}
8218 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
8219 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
8220 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
8221 tags of a headline occasionally.
8223 @orgcmd{:,org-agenda-set-tags}
8224 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
8225 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
8229 Set the priority for the current item (@command{org-agenda-priority}).
8230 Org mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC},
8231 the priority cookie is removed from the entry.
8233 @orgcmd{P,org-agenda-show-priority}
8234 Display weighted priority of current item.
8236 @orgcmdkkc{+,S-@key{up},org-agenda-priority-up}
8237 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
8238 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
8241 @orgcmdkkc{-,S-@key{down},org-agenda-priority-down}
8242 Decrease the priority of the current item.
8244 @orgcmdkkc{z,C-c C-z,org-agenda-add-note}
8245 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
8246 Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then filed to the
8247 same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
8248 @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this may be inside a drawer.
8250 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
8251 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
8253 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-agenda-schedule}
8254 Schedule this item. With prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
8256 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-agenda-deadline}
8257 Set a deadline for this item. With prefix arg remove the deadline.
8259 @orgcmd{k,org-agenda-action}
8260 Agenda actions, to set dates for selected items to the cursor date.
8261 This command also works in the calendar! The command prompts for an
8264 m @r{Mark the entry at point for action. You can also make entries}
8265 @r{in Org files with @kbd{C-c C-x C-k}.}
8266 d @r{Set the deadline of the marked entry to the date at point.}
8267 s @r{Schedule the marked entry at the date at point.}
8268 r @r{Call @code{org-capture} with the cursor date as default date.}
8271 Press @kbd{r} afterward to refresh the agenda and see the effect of the
8274 @orgcmd{S-@key{right},org-agenda-do-date-later}
8275 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
8276 future. If the date is in the past, the first call to this command will move
8278 With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For example,
8279 @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
8280 change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the command, it will
8281 continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With a double @kbd{C-u
8282 C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes.@*
8283 The stamp is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly
8284 reflected in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
8286 @orgcmd{S-@key{left},org-agenda-do-date-earlier}
8287 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
8290 @orgcmd{>,org-agenda-date-prompt}
8291 Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
8292 been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
8294 @orgcmd{I,org-agenda-clock-in}
8295 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
8298 @orgcmd{O,org-agenda-clock-out}
8299 Stop the previously started clock.
8301 @orgcmd{X,org-agenda-clock-cancel}
8302 Cancel the currently running clock.
8304 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8305 Jump to the running clock in another window.
8307 @tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
8308 @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
8310 @orgcmd{m,org-agenda-bulk-mark}
8311 Mark the entry at point for bulk action. With prefix arg, mark that many
8314 @orgcmd{%,org-agenda-bulk-mark-regexp}
8315 Mark entries matching a regular expression for bulk action.
8317 @orgcmd{u,org-agenda-bulk-unmark}
8318 Unmark entry for bulk action.
8320 @orgcmd{U,org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks}
8321 Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
8323 @orgcmd{B,org-agenda-bulk-action}
8324 Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
8325 another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
8326 will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
8327 these special timestamps.
8329 r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
8330 @r{will no longer be in the agenda; refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
8331 $ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
8332 A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
8333 t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
8334 @r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
8335 @r{suppressing logging notes (but not timestamps).}
8336 + @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
8337 - @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
8338 s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
8339 @r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
8340 @r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
8341 S @r{Reschedule randomly into the coming N days. N will be prompted for.}
8342 @r{With prefix arg (@kbd{C-u B S}), scatter only across weekdays.}
8343 d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
8344 f @r{Apply a function to marked entries.}
8345 @r{For example, the function below sets the CATEGORY property of the}
8347 @r{(defun set-category ()}
8348 @r{ (interactive "P")}
8349 @r{ (let* ((marker (or (org-get-at-bol 'org-hd-marker)}
8350 @r{ (org-agenda-error)))}
8351 @r{ (buffer (marker-buffer marker)))}
8352 @r{ (with-current-buffer buffer}
8353 @r{ (save-excursion}
8354 @r{ (save-restriction}
8356 @r{ (goto-char marker)}
8357 @r{ (org-back-to-heading t)}
8358 @r{ (org-set-property "CATEGORY" "web"))))))}
8362 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
8363 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
8365 @orgcmd{c,org-agenda-goto-calendar}
8366 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
8368 @orgcmd{c,org-calendar-goto-agenda}
8369 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org mode agenda for the
8372 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
8373 @orgcmd{i,org-agenda-diary-entry}
8374 @vindex org-agenda-diary-file
8375 Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
8376 block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
8377 file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
8378 @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
8379 command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
8380 you can add the entry.
8382 If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org mode file,
8383 Org will create entries (in Org mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
8384 entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
8385 easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
8386 built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
8387 top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text---if you specify
8388 it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
8389 interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
8390 text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
8391 entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
8393 @orgcmd{M,org-agenda-phases-of-moon}
8394 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
8396 @orgcmd{S,org-agenda-sunrise-sunset}
8397 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
8398 with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
8400 @orgcmd{C,org-agenda-convert-date}
8401 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
8404 @orgcmd{H,org-agenda-holidays}
8405 Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
8407 @item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
8408 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
8409 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
8411 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
8412 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-write-agenda}
8413 @cindex exporting agenda views
8414 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8415 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8416 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8417 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8418 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
8419 and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
8420 argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
8421 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8422 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
8424 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
8425 @orgcmd{q,org-agenda-quit}
8426 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
8428 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
8429 @orgcmd{x,org-agenda-exit}
8430 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
8431 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
8432 visit Org files will not be removed.
8436 @node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
8437 @section Custom agenda views
8438 @cindex custom agenda views
8439 @cindex agenda views, custom
8441 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
8442 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
8443 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
8444 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
8447 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
8448 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
8449 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
8452 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
8453 @subsection Storing searches
8455 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
8456 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
8457 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
8460 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8461 Custom commands are configured in the variable
8462 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
8463 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with
8464 Emacs Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid
8469 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8470 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
8471 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
8472 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
8473 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
8474 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
8475 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
8476 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
8477 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
8478 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
8479 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
8484 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
8485 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
8486 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
8487 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
8488 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
8489 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
8490 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
8491 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
8492 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
8497 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
8500 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
8501 results as a sparse tree
8503 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
8506 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
8507 headlines that are also TODO items
8509 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
8510 displaying the result as a sparse tree
8512 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
8513 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
8515 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
8516 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
8517 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
8520 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
8521 @subsection Block agenda
8522 @cindex block agenda
8523 @cindex agenda, with block views
8525 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
8526 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
8527 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
8528 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
8529 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
8530 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
8531 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
8535 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8536 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8540 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8548 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
8549 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
8550 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
8551 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
8552 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
8554 @node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
8555 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
8556 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
8558 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8559 Org mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
8560 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
8561 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
8562 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
8563 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
8564 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
8568 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8569 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
8570 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
8571 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
8572 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
8573 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
8574 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
8576 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
8577 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
8582 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
8583 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
8584 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
8585 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
8586 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
8587 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
8588 to only a single file.
8590 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8591 For command sets creating a block agenda,
8592 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
8593 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
8594 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
8595 the set. The former are just added to the command entry; the latter
8596 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
8597 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
8598 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
8599 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
8600 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
8604 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8605 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8609 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
8610 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
8611 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8618 As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
8619 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
8620 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
8621 this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
8622 value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
8626 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
8627 @section Exporting Agenda Views
8628 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8630 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
8631 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org mode can export custom
8632 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
8633 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
8634 ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
8635 a PDF file will also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
8636 you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
8639 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-write-agenda}
8640 @cindex exporting agenda views
8641 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8642 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8643 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8644 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8645 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
8646 @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
8647 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8648 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
8650 @vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
8651 @vindex htmlize-output-type
8652 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
8653 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
8655 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
8656 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8657 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8658 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
8659 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
8663 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
8664 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
8665 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
8666 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
8667 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
8668 that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
8669 TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
8670 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
8671 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
8676 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8677 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
8678 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
8679 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8684 ("~/views/home.html"))
8685 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8690 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
8694 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
8695 @file{.html}, Org mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
8696 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
8697 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
8698 Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
8699 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
8700 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
8701 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
8703 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
8704 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
8705 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
8709 @orgcmd{C-c a e,org-store-agenda-views}
8710 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
8714 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
8715 set options for the export commands. For example:
8718 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8720 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8721 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8722 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
8723 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
8724 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
8729 This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
8730 print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
8731 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
8732 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
8733 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
8734 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
8735 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
8736 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
8737 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
8740 From the command line you may also use
8742 emacs -eval (org-batch-store-agenda-views) -kill
8745 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
8746 system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
8748 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
8749 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
8750 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
8751 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
8752 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
8756 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
8757 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
8760 You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
8761 processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
8765 @node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
8766 @section Using column view in the agenda
8767 @cindex column view, in agenda
8768 @cindex agenda, column view
8770 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
8771 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
8772 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
8773 collected by certain criteria.
8776 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8777 Turn on column view in the agenda.
8780 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
8781 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
8782 This causes the following issues:
8786 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8787 @vindex org-overriding-columns-format
8788 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
8789 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
8790 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
8791 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-agenda-overriding-columns-format} is
8792 currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
8793 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
8794 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
8795 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
8797 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
8798 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
8799 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
8800 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
8801 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
8802 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
8803 cover a single day; in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
8804 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
8805 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
8806 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
8807 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
8808 some values will count double.
8810 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
8811 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
8812 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
8813 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
8814 a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
8815 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
8816 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
8821 @node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
8822 @chapter Markup for rich export
8824 When exporting Org mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
8825 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
8826 export targets like HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
8827 Org mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
8828 summarizes the markup rules used in an Org mode buffer.
8831 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
8832 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
8833 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
8834 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
8835 * Index entries:: Making an index
8836 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
8837 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
8840 @node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
8841 @section Structural markup elements
8844 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
8845 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
8846 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
8847 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
8849 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
8850 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
8851 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
8852 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
8853 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
8856 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
8857 @subheading Document title
8858 @cindex document title, markup rules
8861 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
8865 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
8869 If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
8870 non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
8871 turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
8872 title will be the file name without extension.
8874 @cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
8875 If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
8876 of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
8877 property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
8879 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
8880 @subheading Headings and sections
8881 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
8883 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
8884 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
8885 Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
8886 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
8887 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
8888 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
8889 switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
8890 per-file basis with a line
8897 @node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
8898 @subheading Table of contents
8899 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
8901 @vindex org-export-with-toc
8902 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
8903 of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
8904 string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
8905 location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
8906 number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
8907 the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
8908 @code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
8911 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
8912 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
8915 @node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
8916 @subheading Text before the first headline
8917 @cindex text before first headline, markup rules
8920 Org mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
8921 the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
8922 you need to include literal HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
8923 constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
8925 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
8926 Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
8927 internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
8928 the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
8929 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
8930 basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
8933 If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
8934 @code{#+TEXT} construct:
8938 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
8939 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
8940 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the *first* headline
8943 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
8945 @cindex lists, markup rules
8947 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
8948 syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
8951 @node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
8952 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
8953 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
8955 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
8956 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
8958 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
8959 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
8961 @cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
8964 Great clouds overhead
8965 Tiny black birds rise and fall
8972 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
8973 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
8974 can include quotations in Org mode documents like this:
8976 @cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
8979 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
8980 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
8984 If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
8985 @cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
8988 Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
8994 @node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
8995 @subheading Footnote markup
8996 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
8997 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
8999 Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported
9000 by all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
9001 multiple footnotes side by side.
9003 @node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
9004 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
9006 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
9007 @cindex bold text, markup rules
9008 @cindex italic text, markup rules
9009 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
9010 @cindex code text, markup rules
9011 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
9012 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
9013 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
9014 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org mode specific
9015 syntax; it is exported verbatim.
9017 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
9018 @subheading Horizontal rules
9019 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
9020 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be exported as
9021 a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML and @code{\hrule} in @LaTeX{}).
9023 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
9024 @subheading Comment lines
9025 @cindex comment lines
9026 @cindex exporting, not
9027 @cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
9029 Lines starting with @samp{#} in column zero are treated as comments and will
9030 never be exported. If you want an indented line to be treated as a comment,
9031 start it with @samp{#+ }. Also entire subtrees starting with the word
9032 @samp{COMMENT} will never be exported. Finally, regions surrounded by
9033 @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT} ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
9038 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
9042 @node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
9043 @section Images and Tables
9045 @cindex tables, markup rules
9048 Both the native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
9049 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org mode tables,
9050 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
9051 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
9052 a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
9053 the object with @code{\ref@{tab:basic-data@}}:
9056 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
9057 #+LABEL: tab:basic-data
9062 Optionally, the caption can take the form:
9064 #+CAPTION: [Caption for list of figures]@{Caption for table (or link).@}
9067 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
9068 Some backends (HTML, @LaTeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
9069 images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
9070 files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
9071 If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
9072 cross references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede
9073 it with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+LABEL} as follows:
9076 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
9077 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
9081 You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
9082 backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
9085 @xref{Handling links,the discussion of image links}.
9087 @node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
9088 @section Literal examples
9089 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
9090 @cindex code line references, markup rules
9092 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
9093 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
9094 for source code and similar examples.
9095 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
9099 Some example from a text file.
9103 Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
9104 indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
9105 lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
9106 example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
9107 whitespace before the colon:
9111 : Some example from a text file.
9114 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
9115 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
9116 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
9117 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{This works automatically for
9118 the HTML backend (it requires version 1.34 of the @file{htmlize.el} package,
9119 which is distributed with Org). Fontified code chunks in @LaTeX{} can be
9120 achieved using either the listings or the
9121 @url{http://code.google.com/p/minted, minted,} package. To use listings, turn
9122 on the variable @code{org-export-latex-listings} and ensure that the listings
9123 package is included by the @LaTeX{} header (e.g.@: by configuring
9124 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}). See the listings documentation for
9125 configuration options, including obtaining colored output. For minted it is
9126 necessary to install the program @url{http://pygments.org, pygments}, in
9127 addition to setting @code{org-export-latex-minted}, ensuring that the minted
9128 package is included by the @LaTeX{} header, and ensuring that the
9129 @code{-shell-escape} option is passed to @file{pdflatex} (see
9130 @code{org-latex-to-pdf-process}). See the documentation of the variables
9131 @code{org-export-latex-listings} and @code{org-export-latex-minted} for
9132 further details.}. This is done with the @samp{src} block, where you also
9133 need to specify the name of the major mode that should be used to fontify the
9134 example@footnote{Code in @samp{src} blocks may also be evaluated either
9135 interactively or on export. See @pxref{Working With Source Code} for more
9136 information on evaluating code blocks.}, see @ref{Easy Templates} for
9137 shortcuts to easily insert code blocks.
9141 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
9142 (defun org-xor (a b)
9148 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
9149 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
9150 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
9151 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
9152 Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
9153 targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e.@: the reference name
9154 enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
9155 link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
9158 You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
9159 source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
9160 labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
9161 be useful to explain those in an Org mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
9162 switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
9163 the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
9167 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
9168 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
9169 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
9171 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
9175 @vindex org-coderef-label-format
9176 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
9177 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
9178 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
9180 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas (@pxref{Text
9181 areas in HTML export}).
9183 Because the @code{#+BEGIN_...} and @code{#+END_...} patterns need to be added
9184 so often, shortcuts are provided using the Easy Templates facility
9185 (@pxref{Easy Templates}).
9190 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
9191 switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
9192 pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*}
9193 or @samp{#} will get a comma prepended, to keep them from being interpreted
9194 by Org as outline nodes or special comments. These commas will be stripped
9195 for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}. The edited version will
9196 then replace the old version in the Org buffer. Fixed-width regions
9197 (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space) will be edited
9198 using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select a different-mode with the
9199 variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.} to allow creating ASCII
9200 drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line will create a new
9204 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
9205 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label. Make sure
9206 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
9207 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
9208 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
9212 @node Include files, Index entries, Literal examples, Markup
9213 @section Include files
9214 @cindex include files, markup rules
9216 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
9217 include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
9221 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
9224 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g.@: @samp{quote},
9225 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
9226 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional; if it is not
9227 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org mode format and will be
9228 processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
9229 parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
9230 first line and for each following line, @code{:minlevel} in order to get
9231 Org mode content demoted to a specified level, as well as any options
9232 accepted by the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item,
9236 #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
9239 You can also include a portion of a file by specifying a lines range using
9240 the @code{:lines} parameter. The line at the upper end of the range will not
9241 be included. The start and/or the end of the range may be omitted to use the
9245 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "5-10" @r{Include lines 5 to 10, 10 excluded}
9246 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "-10" @r{Include lines 1 to 10, 10 excluded}
9247 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "10-" @r{Include lines from 10 to EOF}
9253 Visit the include file at point.
9256 @node Index entries, Macro replacement, Include files, Markup
9257 @section Index entries
9258 @cindex index entries, for publishing
9260 You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
9261 publishing. This is done by lines starting with @code{#+INDEX}. An entry
9262 the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See @ref{Generating
9263 an index} for more information.
9268 #+INDEX: Application!CV
9274 @node Macro replacement, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Index entries, Markup
9275 @section Macro replacement
9276 @cindex macro replacement, during export
9279 You can define text snippets with
9282 #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
9285 @noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
9286 code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
9287 defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
9288 will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
9289 similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
9290 @code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
9291 and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
9292 @var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
9293 @code{format-time-string}.
9295 Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
9296 construct complex HTML code.
9299 @node Embedded @LaTeX{}, , Macro replacement, Markup
9300 @section Embedded @LaTeX{}
9301 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
9302 @cindex @LaTeX{} interpretation
9304 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. Exceptions
9305 include scientific notes, which often require mathematical symbols and the
9306 occasional formula. @LaTeX{}@footnote{@LaTeX{} is a macro system based on
9307 Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the features described here as
9308 ``@LaTeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for simplicity I am blurring this
9309 distinction.} is widely used to typeset scientific documents. Org mode
9310 supports embedding @LaTeX{} code into its files, because many academics are
9311 used to writing and reading @LaTeX{} source code, and because it can be
9312 readily processed to produce pretty output for a number of export backends.
9315 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
9316 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
9317 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
9318 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
9319 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
9322 @node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9323 @subsection Special symbols
9324 @cindex math symbols
9325 @cindex special symbols
9326 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9327 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, markup rules
9328 @cindex HTML entities
9329 @cindex @LaTeX{} entities
9331 You can use @LaTeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
9332 indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
9333 for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
9334 and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike @LaTeX{}
9335 code, Org mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
9336 delimiters, for example:
9339 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
9342 @vindex org-entities
9343 During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
9344 the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
9345 @code{α} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the @LaTeX{}
9346 output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{ } in HTML and
9347 @code{~} in @LaTeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
9348 like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
9350 A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
9351 @LaTeX{}; see the variable @code{org-entities} for the complete list.
9352 @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
9353 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
9354 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
9356 If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF8 characters, use the
9357 following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
9358 variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
9359 @code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
9364 Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not change the
9365 buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF-8 character
9366 for display purposes only.
9369 @node Subscripts and superscripts, @LaTeX{} fragments, Special symbols, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9370 @subsection Subscripts and superscripts
9374 Just like in @LaTeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
9375 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
9376 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
9377 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
9378 with curly braces. For example
9381 The mass of the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
9382 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
9385 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
9386 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
9387 @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
9388 where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
9389 to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
9390 variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
9391 convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
9397 @noindent With this setting, @samp{a_b} will not be interpreted as a
9398 subscript, but @samp{a_@{b@}} will.
9403 In addition to showing entities as UTF-8 characters, this command will also
9404 format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
9407 @node @LaTeX{} fragments, Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9408 @subsection @LaTeX{} fragments
9409 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9411 @vindex org-format-latex-header
9412 Going beyond symbols and sub- and superscripts, a full formula language is
9413 needed. Org mode can contain @LaTeX{} math fragments, and it supports ways
9414 to process these for several export backends. When exporting to @LaTeX{},
9415 the code is obviously left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org invokes the
9416 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax library} (@pxref{Math formatting in
9417 HTML export}) to process and display the math@footnote{If you plan to use
9418 this regularly or on pages with significant page views, you should install
9419 @file{MathJax} on your own
9420 server in order to limit the load of our server.}. Finally, it can also
9421 process the mathematical expressions into images@footnote{For this to work
9422 you need to be on a system with a working @LaTeX{} installation. You also
9423 need the @file{dvipng} program, available at
9424 @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/}. The @LaTeX{} header that will
9425 be used when processing a fragment can be configured with the variable
9426 @code{org-format-latex-header}.} that can be displayed in a browser or in
9429 @LaTeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
9430 snippets will be identified as @LaTeX{} source code:
9433 Environments of any kind@footnote{When @file{MathJax} is used, only the
9434 environment recognized by @file{MathJax} will be processed. When
9435 @file{dvipng} is used to create images, any @LaTeX{} environments will be
9436 handled.}. The only requirement is that the @code{\begin} statement appears
9437 on a new line, preceded by only whitespace.
9439 Text within the usual @LaTeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
9440 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
9441 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
9442 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
9443 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
9444 For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
9445 @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
9448 @noindent For example:
9451 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
9452 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
9453 \end@{equation@} % etc
9455 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
9456 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
9460 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9461 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
9462 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
9463 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the @LaTeX{} converter.
9465 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
9466 @LaTeX{} processing can be configured with the variable
9467 @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}. The default setting is @code{t}
9468 which means @file{MathJax} for HTML, and no processing for DocBook, ASCII and
9469 @LaTeX{} backends. You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one
9473 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t @r{Do the right thing automatically (MathJax)}
9474 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng @r{Force using dvipng images}
9475 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:nil @r{Do not process @LaTeX{} fragments at all}
9476 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:verbatim @r{Verbatim export, for jsMath or so}
9479 @node Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, CDLaTeX mode, @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9480 @subsection Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments
9481 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, preview
9483 If you have @file{dvipng} installed, @LaTeX{} fragments can be processed to
9484 produce preview images of the typeset expressions:
9489 Produce a preview image of the @LaTeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
9490 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
9491 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
9492 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
9493 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
9494 process the entire buffer.
9497 Remove the overlay preview images.
9500 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9501 You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
9502 some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
9503 export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
9506 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9507 @subsection Using CD@LaTeX{} to enter math
9510 CD@LaTeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
9511 major @LaTeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
9512 environments and math templates. Inside Org mode, you can make use of
9513 some of the features of CD@LaTeX{} mode. You need to install
9514 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
9515 AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
9516 Don't use CD@LaTeX{} mode itself under Org mode, but use the light
9517 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org mode. Turn it
9518 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
9522 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
9525 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
9526 details see the documentation of CD@LaTeX{} mode):
9530 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
9533 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
9534 @LaTeX{} fragment@footnote{Org mode has a method to test if the cursor is
9535 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
9536 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
9537 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
9538 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
9539 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
9540 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
9541 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
9542 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
9543 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
9547 @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
9548 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a @LaTeX{} fragment will insert these
9549 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
9550 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
9551 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
9552 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
9555 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
9556 macros, also outside @LaTeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
9557 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
9560 Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
9561 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
9562 1.5 seconds after the single-quote, a help window will pop up. Character
9563 modification will work only inside @LaTeX{} fragments; outside the quote
9567 @node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
9571 Org mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
9572 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
9573 version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
9574 the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
9575 broad range of other applications. @LaTeX{} export lets you use Org mode and
9576 its structured editing functions to easily create @LaTeX{} files. DocBook
9577 export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
9578 DocBook tools. OpenDocument Text (ODT) export allows seamless
9579 collaboration across organizational boundaries. For project management you
9580 can create gantt and resource charts by using TaskJuggler export. To
9581 incorporate entries with associated times like deadlines or appointments into
9582 a desktop calendar program like iCal, Org mode can also produce extracts in
9583 the iCalendar format. Currently, Org mode only supports export, not import of
9584 these different formats.
9586 Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
9587 enabled (default in Emacs 23).
9590 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
9591 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
9592 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
9593 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
9594 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
9595 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
9596 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
9597 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
9598 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
9599 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
9600 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
9601 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
9604 @node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
9605 @section Selective export
9606 @cindex export, selective by tags or TODO keyword
9608 @vindex org-export-select-tags
9609 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
9610 @cindex org-export-with-tasks
9611 You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
9612 or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
9613 @code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags},
9614 respectively defaulting to @code{'(:export:)} and @code{'(:noexport:)}.
9618 Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the
9619 buffer. If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be
9620 excluded. If a selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it
9621 will also be selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
9624 If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
9628 Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
9629 be removed from the export buffer.
9632 The variable @code{org-export-with-tasks} can be configured to select which
9633 kind of tasks should be included for export. See the docstring of the
9634 variable for more information.
9636 @node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
9637 @section Export options
9638 @cindex options, for export
9640 @cindex completion, of option keywords
9641 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
9642 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
9643 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
9644 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
9645 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
9646 (@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
9647 specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
9648 In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
9649 a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
9652 @orgcmd{C-c C-e t,org-insert-export-options-template}
9653 Insert template with export options, see example below.
9660 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION
9668 @cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
9669 @cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
9671 @cindex #+LaTeX_HEADER
9672 @vindex user-full-name
9673 @vindex user-mail-address
9674 @vindex org-export-default-language
9675 @vindex org-export-date-timestamp-format
9677 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
9678 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
9679 #+DATE: a date, an Org timestamp@footnote{@code{org-export-date-timestamp-format} defines how this timestamp will be exported.}, or a format string for @code{format-time-string}
9680 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
9681 #+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g.@: for the XHTML meta tag
9682 #+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g.@: for the XHTML meta tag
9683 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g.@: @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
9684 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
9685 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
9686 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
9687 #+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g.@:: @code{org-export-latex-low-levels itemize}
9688 @r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
9689 #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
9690 #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
9691 #+LaTeX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the @LaTeX{} header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
9692 #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
9693 #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
9694 #+XSLT: the XSLT stylesheet used by DocBook exporter to generate FO file
9698 The @code{#+OPTIONS} line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
9699 this way, you can use several @code{#+OPTIONS} lines.} form to specify export
9700 settings. Here you can:
9701 @cindex headline levels
9702 @cindex section-numbers
9703 @cindex table of contents
9704 @cindex line-break preservation
9705 @cindex quoted HTML tags
9706 @cindex fixed-width sections
9708 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
9710 @cindex special strings
9711 @cindex emphasized text
9712 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9713 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9714 @cindex author info, in export
9715 @cindex time info, in export
9716 @vindex org-export-plist-vars
9717 @vindex org-export-author-info
9718 @vindex org-export-creator-info
9719 @vindex org-export-email-info
9720 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
9722 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
9723 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
9724 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
9725 \n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)}
9726 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
9727 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
9728 |: @r{turn on/off tables}
9729 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
9730 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
9731 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
9732 -: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
9733 f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
9734 todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
9735 tasks: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tasks (TODO items), can be nil to remove}
9736 @r{all tasks, @code{todo} to remove DONE tasks, or list of kwds to keep}
9737 pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
9738 tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
9739 <: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
9740 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
9741 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
9742 LaTeX: @r{configure export of @LaTeX{} fragments. Default @code{auto}}
9743 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
9744 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
9745 email: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author email into exported file}
9746 creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
9747 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
9748 d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers, or list drawers to include}
9751 These options take effect in both the HTML and @LaTeX{} export, except for
9752 @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX} options, which are respectively @code{t} and
9753 @code{nil} for the @LaTeX{} export.
9755 The default values for these and many other options are given by a set of
9756 variables. For a list of such variables, the corresponding OPTIONS keys and
9757 also the publishing keys (@pxref{Project alist}), see the constant
9758 @code{org-export-plist-vars}.
9760 When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
9761 calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
9762 settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
9763 @code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
9764 @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
9766 @node The export dispatcher, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Export options, Exporting
9767 @section The export dispatcher
9768 @cindex dispatcher, for export commands
9770 All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
9771 prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
9772 Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
9773 contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
9774 the subtrees are exported.
9777 @orgcmd{C-c C-e,org-export}
9778 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9779 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
9780 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
9781 command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
9782 @kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
9783 separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
9784 the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
9785 @orgcmd{C-c C-e v,org-export-visible}
9786 Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
9787 (i.e.@: not hidden by outline visibility).
9788 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-e,org-export}
9789 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9790 Call the exporter, but reverse the setting of
9791 @code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e.@: request background processing if
9792 not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
9795 @node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
9796 @section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
9797 @cindex ASCII export
9798 @cindex Latin-1 export
9799 @cindex UTF-8 export
9801 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org mode
9802 file, containing only plain ASCII. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment the file
9803 with special characters and symbols available in these encodings.
9805 @cindex region, active
9806 @cindex active region
9807 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9809 @orgcmd{C-c C-e a,org-export-as-ascii}
9810 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9811 Export as ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
9812 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
9813 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9814 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9815 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9816 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
9817 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
9818 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
9820 @orgcmd{C-c C-e A,org-export-as-ascii-to-buffer}
9821 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
9822 @orgcmd{C-c C-e n,org-export-as-latin1}
9823 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e N,org-export-as-latin1-to-buffer}
9824 Like the above commands, but use Latin-1 encoding.
9825 @orgcmd{C-c C-e u,org-export-as-utf8}
9826 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e U,org-export-as-utf8-to-buffer}
9827 Like the above commands, but use UTF-8 encoding.
9828 @item C-c C-e v a/n/u
9829 Export only the visible part of the document.
9832 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9833 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
9834 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
9835 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
9836 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
9843 creates only top level headlines and exports the rest as items. When
9844 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
9845 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
9846 the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
9847 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
9848 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
9849 indentation than the first one, these are left alone.
9851 @vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
9852 Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
9853 the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
9854 @code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
9856 @node HTML export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Exporting
9857 @section HTML export
9860 Org mode contains an HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
9861 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
9862 language, but with additional support for tables.
9865 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
9866 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
9867 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
9868 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
9869 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
9870 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
9871 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
9872 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
9873 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
9874 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
9877 @node HTML Export commands, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export, HTML export
9878 @subsection HTML export commands
9880 @cindex region, active
9881 @cindex active region
9882 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9884 @orgcmd{C-c C-e h,org-export-as-html}
9885 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9886 Export as HTML file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
9887 the HTML file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
9888 without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9889 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9890 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9891 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
9892 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
9893 property, that name will be used for the export.
9894 @orgcmd{C-c C-e b,org-export-as-html-and-open}
9895 Export as HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
9896 @orgcmd{C-c C-e H,org-export-as-html-to-buffer}
9897 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
9898 @orgcmd{C-c C-e R,org-export-region-as-html}
9899 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
9900 not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
9901 the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
9902 @item C-c C-e v h/b/H/R
9903 Export only the visible part of the document.
9904 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html
9905 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was Org mode
9906 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
9908 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
9909 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by HTML
9913 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9914 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
9915 defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
9916 itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
9917 specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
9924 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
9927 @node HTML preamble and postamble, Quoting HTML tags, HTML Export commands, HTML export
9928 @subsection HTML preamble and postamble
9929 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
9930 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
9931 @vindex org-export-html-preamble-format
9932 @vindex org-export-html-postamble-format
9933 @vindex org-export-html-validation-link
9934 @vindex org-export-author-info
9935 @vindex org-export-email-info
9936 @vindex org-export-creator-info
9937 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
9939 The HTML exporter lets you define a preamble and a postamble.
9941 The default value for @code{org-export-html-preamble} is @code{t}, which
9942 means that the preamble is inserted depending on the relevant format string
9943 in @code{org-export-html-preamble-format}.
9945 Setting @code{org-export-html-preamble} to a string will override the default
9946 format string. Setting it to a function, will insert the output of the
9947 function, which must be a string; such a function takes no argument but you
9948 can check against the value of @code{opt-plist}, which contains the list of
9949 publishing properties for the current file. Setting to @code{nil} will not
9950 insert any preamble.
9952 The default value for @code{org-export-html-postamble} is @code{'auto}, which
9953 means that the HTML exporter will look for the value of
9954 @code{org-export-author-info}, @code{org-export-email-info},
9955 @code{org-export-creator-info} and @code{org-export-time-stamp-file},
9956 @code{org-export-html-validation-link} and build the postamble from these
9957 values. Setting @code{org-export-html-postamble} to @code{t} will insert the
9958 postamble from the relevant format string found in
9959 @code{org-export-html-postamble-format}. Setting it to @code{nil} will not
9960 insert any postamble.
9962 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export
9963 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
9965 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{<} and
9966 @samp{>} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
9967 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
9968 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
9969 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
9970 the exported file use either
9973 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
9975 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
9979 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
9983 All lines between these markers are exported literally
9988 @node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
9989 @subsection Links in HTML export
9991 @cindex links, in HTML export
9992 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
9993 @cindex external links, in HTML export
9994 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML. This
9995 includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
9996 targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
9997 the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
9998 @file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
9999 that an HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
10000 path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
10001 files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
10002 publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
10004 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
10005 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
10006 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
10007 and @code{style} attributes for a link:
10009 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10011 #+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org mode homepage" style="color:red;"
10012 [[http://orgmode.org]]
10015 @node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
10017 @cindex tables, in HTML
10018 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
10020 Org mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
10021 @code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
10022 cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
10023 tables, place something like the following before the table:
10026 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10028 #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
10029 #+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="border"
10032 @node Images in HTML export, Math formatting in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
10033 @subsection Images in HTML export
10035 @cindex images, inline in HTML
10036 @cindex inlining images in HTML
10037 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
10038 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
10039 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
10040 default@footnote{But see the variable
10041 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
10042 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
10043 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
10044 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
10045 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
10046 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
10047 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
10048 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
10051 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
10054 If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
10055 In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
10056 support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
10059 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10061 #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
10062 #+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
10067 You could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
10069 @node Math formatting in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Images in HTML export, HTML export
10070 @subsection Math formatting in HTML export
10074 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be displayed in two
10075 different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use the
10076 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax system} which should work out of the
10077 box with Org mode installation because @code{http://orgmode.org} serves
10078 @file{MathJax} for Org mode users for small applications and for testing
10079 purposes. @b{If you plan to use this regularly or on pages with significant
10080 page views, you should install@footnote{Installation instructions can be
10081 found on the MathJax website, see
10082 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org/resources/docs/?installation.html}.} MathJax on
10083 your own server in order to limit the load of our server.} To configure
10084 @file{MathJax}, use the variable @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} or
10085 insert something like the following into the buffer:
10088 #+MATHJAX: align:"left" mathml:t path:"/MathJax/MathJax.js"
10091 @noindent See the docstring of the variable
10092 @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} for the meaning of the parameters in
10095 If you prefer, you can also request that @LaTeX{} fragments are processed
10096 into small images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before the
10097 availability of MathJax, this was the default method for Org files. This
10098 method requires that the @file{dvipng} program is available on your system.
10099 You can still get this processing with
10102 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
10105 @node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Math formatting in HTML export, HTML export
10106 @subsection Text areas in HTML export
10108 @cindex text areas, in HTML
10109 An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
10110 areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
10111 application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
10112 @code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
10113 label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
10114 use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
10115 text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
10116 respectively. For example
10119 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
10120 (defun org-xor (a b)
10127 @node CSS support, JavaScript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
10128 @subsection CSS support
10129 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
10130 @cindex HTML export, CSS
10132 @vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
10133 @vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
10134 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
10135 assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
10136 keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
10137 @code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
10138 @code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
10139 parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
10140 addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
10142 p.author @r{author information, including email}
10143 p.date @r{publishing date}
10144 p.creator @r{creator info, about org mode version}
10145 .title @r{document title}
10146 .todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
10147 .done @r{the DONE keywords, all states that count as done}
10148 .WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
10149 .timestamp @r{timestamp}
10150 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
10151 .timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
10152 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
10153 ._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
10154 .target @r{target for links}
10155 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
10156 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
10157 div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
10158 div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
10159 .section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
10160 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
10161 pre.src @r{formatted source code}
10162 pre.example @r{normal example}
10163 p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
10164 div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
10165 p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
10166 .footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
10167 .footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
10170 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10171 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
10172 @vindex org-export-html-style
10173 @vindex org-export-html-extra
10174 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10175 Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
10176 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
10177 @code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
10178 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
10179 @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
10180 settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
10181 (for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
10182 fine-grained settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
10183 individually for each file, you can use
10187 #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
10191 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
10192 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
10193 referring to an external file.
10195 In order to add styles to a subtree, use the @code{:HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS:}
10196 property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS styles for a
10197 particular headline, you can use the id specified in a @code{:CUSTOM_ID:}
10200 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
10201 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
10203 @node JavaScript support, , CSS support, HTML export
10204 @subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
10206 @cindex Rose, Sebastian
10207 Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
10208 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
10209 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
10210 is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
10211 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
10212 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
10213 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
10214 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
10215 the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
10216 We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
10217 not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
10218 copy on your own web server.
10220 To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
10221 gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
10222 customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
10223 this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
10224 adding a single line to the Org file:
10226 @cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
10228 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
10232 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
10233 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
10237 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
10238 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
10239 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
10240 view: @r{Initial view when the website is first shown. Possible values are:}
10241 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
10242 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
10243 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
10244 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
10245 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
10246 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
10247 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
10248 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
10249 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
10250 toc: @r{Should the table of contents @emph{initially} be visible?}
10251 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
10252 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
10253 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
10254 ftoc: @r{Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
10255 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
10256 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
10257 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
10258 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
10259 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
10260 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
10261 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
10264 @vindex org-infojs-options
10265 @vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
10266 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
10267 @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
10268 pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
10270 @node @LaTeX{} and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
10271 @section @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10272 @cindex @LaTeX{} export
10274 @cindex Guerry, Bastien
10276 Org mode contains a @LaTeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
10277 further processing@footnote{The default @LaTeX{} output is designed for
10278 processing with @code{pdftex} or @LaTeX{}. It includes packages that are not
10279 compatible with @code{xetex} and possibly @code{luatex}. See the variables
10280 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10281 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}.}, this backend is also used to
10282 produce PDF output. Since the @LaTeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to
10283 implement links and cross references, the PDF output file will be fully
10284 linked. Beware of the fact that your @code{org} file has to be properly
10285 structured in order to be correctly exported: respect the hierarchy of
10289 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
10290 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
10291 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
10292 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
10293 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
10294 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
10297 @node @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10298 @subsection @LaTeX{} export commands
10300 @cindex region, active
10301 @cindex active region
10302 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10304 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l,org-export-as-latex}
10305 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10306 Export as @LaTeX{} file. For an Org file
10307 @file{myfile.org}, the @LaTeX{} file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
10308 be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
10309 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10310 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10311 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10312 title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10313 property, that name will be used for the export.
10314 @orgcmd{C-c C-e L,org-export-as-latex-to-buffer}
10315 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10316 @item C-c C-e v l/L
10317 Export only the visible part of the document.
10318 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
10319 Convert the region to @LaTeX{} under the assumption that it was Org mode
10320 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
10322 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
10323 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by @LaTeX{}
10325 @orgcmd{C-c C-e p,org-export-as-pdf}
10326 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF.
10327 @orgcmd{C-c C-e d,org-export-as-pdf-and-open}
10328 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10331 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10332 @vindex org-latex-low-levels
10333 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
10334 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
10335 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
10336 convert them to a custom string depending on
10337 @code{org-latex-low-levels}.
10339 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
10340 with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
10343 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e l}
10347 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
10349 @node Header and sectioning, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10350 @subsection Header and sectioning structure
10351 @cindex @LaTeX{} class
10352 @cindex @LaTeX{} sectioning structure
10353 @cindex @LaTeX{} header
10354 @cindex header, for @LaTeX{} files
10355 @cindex sectioning structure, for @LaTeX{} export
10357 By default, the @LaTeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
10359 @vindex org-export-latex-default-class
10360 @vindex org-export-latex-classes
10361 @vindex org-export-latex-default-packages-alist
10362 @vindex org-export-latex-packages-alist
10363 @cindex #+LaTeX_HEADER
10364 @cindex #+LaTeX_CLASS
10365 @cindex #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10366 @cindex property, LaTeX_CLASS
10367 @cindex property, LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10368 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
10369 @code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
10370 @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
10371 property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
10372 The class must be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}. This variable
10373 defines a header template for each class@footnote{Into which the values of
10374 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10375 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist} are spliced.}, and allows you to
10376 define the sectioning structure for each class. You can also define your own
10377 classes there. @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} or a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS:}
10378 property can specify the options for the @code{\documentclass} macro. The
10379 options to documentclass have to be provided, as expected by @LaTeX{}, within
10380 square brackets. You can also use @code{#+LaTeX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}}
10381 to add lines to the header. See the docstring of
10382 @code{org-export-latex-classes} for more information. An example is shown
10386 #+LaTeX_CLASS: article
10387 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [a4paper]
10388 #+LaTeX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}
10394 @node Quoting @LaTeX{} code, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10395 @subsection Quoting @LaTeX{} code
10397 Embedded @LaTeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded @LaTeX{}}, will be correctly
10398 inserted into the @LaTeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
10399 @samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
10400 you can add special code that should only be present in @LaTeX{} export with
10401 the following constructs:
10404 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10406 #+LaTeX: Literal @LaTeX{} code for export
10410 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10414 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10419 @node Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Images in @LaTeX{} export, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10420 @subsection Tables in @LaTeX{} export
10421 @cindex tables, in @LaTeX{} export
10423 For @LaTeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label, a caption and
10424 placement options (@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the
10425 @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to request a @code{longtable} environment for the
10426 table, so that it may span several pages, or to change the default table
10427 environment from @code{table} to @code{table*} or to change the default inner
10428 tabular environment to @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}. Finally, you can
10429 set the alignment string, and (with @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}) the
10434 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10436 #+CAPTION: A long table
10438 #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
10443 or to specify a multicolumn table with @code{tabulary}
10447 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10449 #+CAPTION: A wide table with tabulary
10451 #+ATTR_LaTeX: table* tabulary width=\textwidth
10456 @node Images in @LaTeX{} export, Beamer class export, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10457 @subsection Images in @LaTeX{} export
10458 @cindex images, inline in @LaTeX{}
10459 @cindex inlining images in @LaTeX{}
10461 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10462 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
10463 output file resulting from @LaTeX{} processing. Org will use an
10464 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
10465 caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
10466 will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
10467 element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify various other
10468 options. You can ask org to export an image as a float without specifying
10469 a label or a caption by using the keyword @code{float} in this line. Various
10470 optional arguments to the @code{\includegraphics} macro can also be specified
10471 in this fashion. To modify the placement option of the floating environment,
10472 add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the attributes. It is to be noted
10473 this option can be used with tables as well@footnote{One can also take
10474 advantage of this option to pass other, unrelated options into the figure or
10475 table environment. For an example see the section ``Exporting org files'' in
10476 @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-hacks.html}}.
10478 If you would like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap}
10479 to the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
10480 half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the set
10481 of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment. Note
10482 that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible settings
10483 for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
10487 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10489 #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
10490 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
10491 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
10492 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
10494 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
10498 If you wish to include an image which spans multiple columns in a page, you
10499 can use the keyword @code{multicolumn} in the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX} line. This
10500 will export the image wrapped in a @code{figure*} environment.
10502 If you need references to a label created in this way, write
10503 @samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in @LaTeX{}.
10505 @node Beamer class export, , Images in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10506 @subsection Beamer class export
10508 The @LaTeX{} class @file{beamer} allows production of high quality presentations
10509 using @LaTeX{} and pdf processing. Org mode has special support for turning an
10510 Org mode file or tree into a @file{beamer} presentation.
10512 When the @LaTeX{} class for the current buffer (as set with @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS:
10513 beamer}) or subtree (set with a @code{LaTeX_CLASS} property) is
10514 @code{beamer}, a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a beamer
10515 presentation. Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should in principle be
10516 exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the top-level entries (or
10517 the first level below the selected subtree heading) will be turned into
10518 frames, and the outline structure below this level will become itemize lists.
10519 You can also configure the variable @code{org-beamer-frame-level} to a
10520 different level---then the hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning
10521 structure of the presentation.
10523 A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted into
10524 the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-insert-beamer-options-template}. Among other
10525 things, this will install a column view format which is very handy for
10526 editing special properties used by beamer.
10528 You can influence the structure of the presentation using the following
10533 The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid environments
10534 are defined in the constant @code{org-beamer-environments-default}, and you
10535 can define more in @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. If this property is
10536 set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to make this
10537 visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
10538 @item BEAMER_envargs
10539 The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the environment, like
10540 @code{[t]} or @code{[<+->]} of @code{<2-3>}. If the @code{BEAMER_col}
10541 property is also set, something like @code{C[t]} can be added here as well to
10542 set an options argument for the implied @code{columns} environment.
10543 @code{c[t]} or @code{c<2->} will set an options for the implied @code{column}
10546 The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this property is
10547 set, the entry will also get a @code{:BMCOL:} property to make this visible.
10548 Also this tag is only a visual aid. When this is a plain number, it will be
10549 interpreted as a fraction of @code{\textwidth}. Otherwise it will be assumed
10550 that you have specified the units, like @samp{3cm}. The first such property
10551 in a frame will start a @code{columns} environment to surround the columns.
10552 This environment is closed when an entry has a @code{BEAMER_col} property
10553 with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the frame.
10555 Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment has been
10556 opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be used to specify
10560 Frames will automatically receive a @code{fragile} option if they contain
10561 source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special @file{beamer}
10562 specific code can be inserted using @code{#+BEAMER:} and
10563 @code{#+BEGIN_BEAMER...#+END_BEAMER} constructs, similar to other export
10564 backends, but with the difference that @code{#+LaTeX:} stuff will be included
10565 in the presentation as well.
10567 Outline nodes with @code{BEAMER_env} property value @samp{note} or
10568 @samp{noteNH} will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped
10569 into @code{\note@{...@}}. The former will include the heading as part of the
10570 note text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
10571 generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a @emph{tag} (either
10572 @code{:B_note:} or @code{:B_noteNH:}) instead of creating the
10573 @code{BEAMER_env} property.
10575 You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for editing
10583 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-beamer-select-environment}
10584 In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a beamer
10585 environment or the @code{BEAMER_col} property.
10588 Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node and other
10589 important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN format that is geared
10590 toward this special purpose. The command @kbd{M-x
10591 org-insert-beamer-options-template} defines such a format.
10593 Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer export.
10596 #+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
10597 #+TITLE: Example Presentation
10598 #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
10599 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
10600 #+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
10601 #+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme@{Madrid@}\usecolortheme@{default@}
10602 #+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
10604 * This is the first structural section
10606 ** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
10607 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
10610 :BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
10613 for the first viable beamer setup in Org
10614 *** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
10618 :BEAMER_envargs: <2->
10620 for contributing to the discussion
10621 **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
10622 ** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
10623 *** Request :B_block:
10624 Please test this stuff!
10630 For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
10632 @node DocBook export, OpenDocument Text export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, Exporting
10633 @section DocBook export
10634 @cindex DocBook export
10636 @cindex Cui, Baoqiu
10638 Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
10639 exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
10640 formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
10641 tools and stylesheets.
10643 Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
10646 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
10647 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
10648 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
10649 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
10650 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
10651 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
10654 @node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
10655 @subsection DocBook export commands
10657 @cindex region, active
10658 @cindex active region
10659 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10661 @orgcmd{C-c C-e D,org-export-as-docbook}
10662 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10663 Export as DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
10664 file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
10665 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10666 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
10667 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10668 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10669 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10670 property, that name will be used for the export.
10671 @orgcmd{C-c C-e V,org-export-as-docbook-pdf-and-open}
10672 Export as DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10674 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
10675 @vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
10676 Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on exported DocBook file, you
10677 need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
10678 system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
10679 @code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
10681 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet
10682 The stylesheet argument @code{%s} in variable
10683 @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} is replaced by the value of
10684 variable @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet}, which needs to be set by
10685 the user. You can also overrule this global setting on a per-file basis by
10686 adding an in-buffer setting @code{#+XSLT:} to the Org file.
10688 @orgkey{C-c C-e v D}
10689 Export only the visible part of the document.
10692 @node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
10693 @subsection Quoting DocBook code
10695 You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
10696 DocBook file with the following constructs:
10699 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10701 #+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
10705 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10709 All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
10714 For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
10715 admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
10716 document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
10717 exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
10722 <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
10723 in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML may be generated by
10724 DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
10729 @node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
10730 @subsection Recursive sections
10731 @cindex DocBook recursive sections
10733 DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
10734 element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e.@: @code{section} elements, are
10735 used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
10736 top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
10737 sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
10738 matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
10740 Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
10741 code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
10743 @node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
10744 @subsection Tables in DocBook export
10745 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
10747 Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
10750 If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
10751 @code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
10752 using the @code{table} element.
10754 @node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
10755 @subsection Images in DocBook export
10756 @cindex images, inline in DocBook
10757 @cindex inlining images in DocBook
10759 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10760 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
10761 using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
10762 an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
10763 specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
10764 @code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
10765 also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
10766 @code{mediaobject} element.
10768 @vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
10769 Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
10770 or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
10771 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
10772 @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
10773 @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
10774 images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overridden by image
10775 attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
10777 The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
10778 attributes or override default image attributes for individual images. If
10779 the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
10780 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
10781 takes precedence. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
10786 @cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
10788 #+CAPTION: The logo of Org mode
10789 #+LABEL: unicorn-svg
10790 #+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
10791 [[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
10794 @vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
10795 By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
10796 @file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
10797 customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
10798 more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
10800 @node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
10801 @subsection Special characters in DocBook export
10802 @cindex Special characters in DocBook export
10804 @vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
10805 @vindex org-entities
10806 Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
10807 @code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
10808 characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{α},
10809 @code{Γ}, and @code{Ζ}, based on the list saved in variable
10810 @code{org-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
10811 corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
10813 You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
10814 entities you need. For example, you can set variable
10815 @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
10816 special characters included in XHTML entities:
10819 "<!DOCTYPE article [
10820 <!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
10821 \"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
10822 \"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
10829 @c begin opendocument
10831 @node OpenDocument Text export, TaskJuggler export, DocBook export, Exporting
10832 @section OpenDocument Text export
10833 @cindex K, Jambunathan
10835 @cindex OpenDocument
10836 @cindex export, OpenDocument
10837 @cindex LibreOffice
10839 @cindex org-modules
10841 Orgmode@footnote{Versions 7.8 or later} supports export to OpenDocument Text
10842 (ODT) format using the @file{org-odt.el} module. Documents created
10843 by this exporter use the @cite{OpenDocument-v1.2
10844 specification}@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
10845 Open Document Format for Office Applications (OpenDocument) Version 1.2}} and
10846 are compatible with LibreOffice 3.4.
10849 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
10850 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
10851 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
10852 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
10853 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
10854 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
10855 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
10856 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
10857 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
10858 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
10859 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
10862 @node Pre-requisites for ODT export, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export, OpenDocument Text export
10863 @subsection Pre-requisites for ODT export
10865 The ODT exporter relies on the @file{zip} program to create the final
10866 output. Check the availability of this program before proceeding further.
10868 @node ODT export commands, Extending ODT export, Pre-requisites for ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
10869 @subsection ODT export commands
10871 @subsubheading Exporting to ODT
10872 @anchor{x-export-to-odt}
10874 @cindex region, active
10875 @cindex active region
10876 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10878 @orgcmd{C-c C-e o,org-export-as-odt}
10879 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10881 Export as OpenDocument Text file.
10883 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
10884 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, automatically
10885 convert the exported file to that format. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, ,
10886 Automatically exporting to other formats}.
10888 For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the ODT file will be
10889 @file{myfile.odt}. The file will be overwritten without warning. If there
10890 is an active region,@footnote{This requires @code{transient-mark-mode} to be
10891 turned on} only the region will be exported. If the selected region is a
10892 single tree,@footnote{To select the current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}} the
10893 tree head will become the document title. If the tree head entry has, or
10894 inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
10897 @orgcmd{C-c C-e O,org-export-as-odt-and-open}
10898 Export as OpenDocument Text file and open the resulting file.
10900 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
10901 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, open the
10902 converted file instead. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, , Automatically
10903 exporting to other formats}.
10906 @node Extending ODT export, Applying custom styles, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export
10907 @subsection Extending ODT export
10909 The ODT exporter can interface with a variety of document
10910 converters and supports popular converters out of the box. As a result, you
10911 can use it to export to formats like @samp{doc} or convert a document from
10912 one format (say @samp{csv}) to another format (say @samp{ods} or @samp{xls}).
10914 @cindex @file{unoconv}
10915 @cindex LibreOffice
10916 If you have a working installation of LibreOffice, a document converter is
10917 pre-configured for you and you can use it right away. If you would like to
10918 use @file{unoconv} as your preferred converter, customize the variable
10919 @code{org-export-odt-convert-process} to point to @code{unoconv}. You can
10920 also use your own favorite converter or tweak the default settings of the
10921 @file{LibreOffice} and @samp{unoconv} converters. @xref{Configuring a
10922 document converter}.
10924 @subsubsection Automatically exporting to other formats
10925 @anchor{x-export-to-other-formats}
10927 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
10928 Very often, you will find yourself exporting to ODT format, only to
10929 immediately save the exported document to other formats like @samp{doc},
10930 @samp{docx}, @samp{rtf}, @samp{pdf} etc. In such cases, you can specify your
10931 preferred output format by customizing the variable
10932 @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format}. This way, the export commands
10933 (@pxref{x-export-to-odt,,Exporting to ODT}) can be extended to export to a
10934 format that is of immediate interest to you.
10936 @subsubsection Converting between document formats
10937 @anchor{x-convert-to-other-formats}
10939 There are many document converters in the wild which support conversion to
10940 and from various file formats, including, but not limited to the
10941 ODT format. LibreOffice converter, mentioned above, is one such
10942 converter. Once a converter is configured, you can interact with it using
10943 the following command.
10945 @vindex org-export-odt-convert
10948 @item M-x org-export-odt-convert
10949 Convert an existing document from one format to another. With a prefix
10950 argument, also open the newly produced file.
10953 @node Applying custom styles, Links in ODT export, Extending ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
10954 @subsection Applying custom styles
10955 @cindex styles, custom
10956 @cindex template, custom
10958 The ODT exporter ships with a set of OpenDocument styles
10959 (@pxref{Working with OpenDocument style files}) that ensure a well-formatted
10960 output. These factory styles, however, may not cater to your specific
10961 tastes. To customize the output, you can either modify the above styles
10962 files directly, or generate the required styles using an application like
10963 LibreOffice. The latter method is suitable for expert and non-expert
10964 users alike, and is described here.
10966 @subsubsection Applying custom styles - the easy way
10970 Create a sample @file{example.org} file with the below settings and export it
10974 #+OPTIONS: H:10 num:t
10978 Open the above @file{example.odt} using LibreOffice. Use the @file{Stylist}
10979 to locate the target styles - these typically have the @samp{Org} prefix -
10980 and modify those to your taste. Save the modified file either as an
10981 OpenDocument Text (@file{.odt}) or OpenDocument Template (@file{.ott}) file.
10984 @cindex #+ODT_STYLES_FILE
10985 @vindex org-export-odt-styles-file
10986 Customize the variable @code{org-export-odt-styles-file} and point it to the
10987 newly created file. For additional configuration options
10988 @pxref{x-overriding-factory-styles,,Overriding factory styles}.
10990 If you would like to choose a style on a per-file basis, you can use the
10991 @code{#+ODT_STYLES_FILE} option. A typical setting will look like
10994 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: "/path/to/example.ott"
11000 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: ("/path/to/file.ott" ("styles.xml" "image/hdr.png"))
11005 @subsubsection Using third-party styles and templates
11007 You can use third-party styles and templates for customizing your output.
11008 This will produce the desired output only if the template provides all
11009 style names that the @samp{ODT} exporter relies on. Unless this condition is
11010 met, the output is going to be less than satisfactory. So it is highly
11011 recommended that you only work with templates that are directly derived from
11012 the factory settings.
11014 @node Links in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, Applying custom styles, OpenDocument Text export
11015 @subsection Links in ODT export
11016 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
11018 ODT exporter creates native cross-references for internal links. It creates
11019 Internet-style links for all other links.
11021 A link with no description and destined to a regular (un-itemized) outline
11022 heading is replaced with a cross-reference and section number of the heading.
11024 A @samp{\ref@{label@}}-style reference to an image, table etc. is replaced
11025 with a cross-reference and sequence number of the labeled entity.
11026 @xref{Labels and captions in ODT export}.
11028 @node Tables in ODT export, Images in ODT export, Links in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11029 @subsection Tables in ODT export
11030 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
11032 Export of native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and simple @file{table.el}
11033 tables is supported. However, export of complex @file{table.el} tables -
11034 tables that have column or row spans - is not supported. Such tables are
11035 stripped from the exported document.
11037 By default, a table is exported with top and bottom frames and with rules
11038 separating row and column groups (@pxref{Column groups}). Furthermore, all
11039 tables are typeset to occupy the same width. If the table specifies
11040 alignment and relative width for its columns (@pxref{Column width and
11041 alignment}) then these are honored on export.@footnote{The column widths are
11042 interpreted as weighted ratios with the default weight being 1}
11045 You can control the width of the table by specifying @code{:rel-width}
11046 property using an @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line.
11048 For example, consider the following table which makes use of all the rules
11052 #+ATTR_ODT: :rel-width 50
11053 | Area/Month | Jan | Feb | Mar | Sum |
11054 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11056 | <l13> | <r5> | <r5> | <r5> | <r6> |
11057 | North America | 1 | 21 | 926 | 948 |
11058 | Middle East | 6 | 75 | 844 | 925 |
11059 | Asia Pacific | 9 | 27 | 790 | 826 |
11060 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11061 | Sum | 16 | 123 | 2560 | 2699 |
11064 On export, the table will occupy 50% of text area. The columns will be sized
11065 (roughly) in the ratio of 13:5:5:5:6. The first column will be left-aligned
11066 and rest of the columns will be right-aligned. There will be vertical rules
11067 after separating the header and last columns from other columns. There will
11068 be horizontal rules separating the header and last rows from other rows.
11070 If you are not satisfied with the above formatting options, you can create
11071 custom table styles and associate them with a table using the
11072 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. @xref{Customizing tables in ODT export}.
11074 @node Images in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11075 @subsection Images in ODT export
11076 @cindex images, embedding in ODT
11077 @cindex embedding images in ODT
11079 @subsubheading Embedding images
11080 You can embed images within the exported document by providing a link to the
11081 desired image file with no link description. For example, to embed
11082 @samp{img.png} do either of the following:
11092 @subsubheading Embedding clickable images
11093 You can create clickable images by providing a link whose description is a
11094 link to an image file. For example, to embed a image
11095 @file{org-mode-unicorn.png} which when clicked jumps to
11096 @uref{http://Orgmode.org} website, do the following
11099 [[http://orgmode.org][./org-mode-unicorn.png]]
11102 @subsubheading Sizing and scaling of embedded images
11105 You can control the size and scale of the embedded images using the
11106 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} attribute.
11108 @cindex identify, ImageMagick
11109 @vindex org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch
11110 The exporter specifies the desired size of the image in the final document in
11111 units of centimeters. In order to scale the embedded images, the exporter
11112 queries for pixel dimensions of the images using one of a) ImageMagick's
11113 @file{identify} program or b) Emacs `create-image' and `image-size'
11114 APIs.@footnote{Use of @file{ImageMagick} is only desirable. However, if you
11115 routinely produce documents that have large images or you export your Org
11116 files that has images using a Emacs batch script, then the use of
11117 @file{ImageMagick} is mandatory.} The pixel dimensions are subsequently
11118 converted in to units of centimeters using
11119 @code{org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch}. The default value of this variable is
11120 set to @code{display-pixels-per-inch}. You can tweak this variable to
11121 achieve the best results.
11123 The examples below illustrate the various possibilities.
11126 @item Explicitly size the image
11127 To embed @file{img.png} as a 10 cm x 10 cm image, do the following:
11130 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10 :height 10
11134 @item Scale the image
11135 To embed @file{img.png} at half its size, do the following:
11138 #+ATTR_ODT: :scale 0.5
11142 @item Scale the image to a specific width
11143 To embed @file{img.png} with a width of 10 cm while retaining the original
11144 height:width ratio, do the following:
11147 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10
11151 @item Scale the image to a specific height
11152 To embed @file{img.png} with a height of 10 cm while retaining the original
11153 height:width ratio, do the following
11156 #+ATTR_ODT: :height 10
11161 @subsubheading Anchoring of images
11164 You can control the manner in which an image is anchored by setting the
11165 @code{:anchor} property of it's @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. You can specify one
11166 of the the following three values for the @code{:anchor} property -
11167 @samp{"as-char"}, @samp{"paragraph"} and @samp{"page"}.
11169 To create an image that is anchored to a page, do the following:
11171 #+ATTR_ODT: :anchor "page"
11175 @node Math formatting in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, Images in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11176 @subsection Math formatting in ODT export
11178 The ODT exporter has special support for handling math.
11181 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
11182 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
11185 @node Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, Math formatting in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export
11186 @subsubsection Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets
11188 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be embedded in the ODT
11189 document in one of the following ways:
11195 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11201 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are first converted into MathML
11202 fragments using an external @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter program. The
11203 resulting MathML fragments are then embedded as an OpenDocument Formula in
11204 the exported document.
11206 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11207 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11209 You can specify the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter by customizing the variables
11210 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command} and
11211 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file}.
11213 If you prefer to use @file{MathToWeb}@footnote{See
11214 @uref{http://www.mathtoweb.com/cgi-bin/mathtoweb_home.pl, MathToWeb}} as your
11215 converter, you can configure the above variables as shown below.
11218 (setq org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11219 "java -jar %j -unicode -force -df %o %I"
11220 org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11221 "/path/to/mathtoweb.jar")
11224 You can use the following commands to quickly verify the reliability of
11225 the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter.
11229 @item M-x org-export-as-odf
11230 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file.
11232 @item M-x org-export-as-odf-and-open
11233 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file and
11234 open the formula file with the system-registered application.
11240 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11243 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
11246 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are processed into PNG images and the
11247 resulting images are embedded in the exported document. This method requires
11248 that the @file{dvipng} program be available on your system.
11251 @node Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, , Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Math formatting in ODT export
11252 @subsubsection Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files
11254 For various reasons, you may find embedding @LaTeX{} math snippets in an
11255 ODT document less than reliable. In that case, you can embed a
11256 math equation by linking to its MathML (@file{.mml}) source or its
11257 OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file as shown below:
11269 @node Labels and captions in ODT export, Literal examples in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11270 @subsection Labels and captions in ODT export
11272 You can label and caption various category of objects - an inline image, a
11273 table, a @LaTeX{} fragment or a Math formula - using @code{#+LABEL} and
11274 @code{#+CAPTION} lines. @xref{Images and tables}. ODT exporter enumerates
11275 each labeled or captioned object of a given category separately. As a
11276 result, each such object is assigned a sequence number based on order of it's
11277 appearance in the Org file.
11279 In the exported document, a user-provided caption is augmented with the
11280 category and sequence number. Consider the following inline image in an Org
11284 #+CAPTION: Bell curve
11285 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
11289 It could be rendered as shown below in the exported document.
11292 Figure 2: Bell curve
11295 @vindex org-export-odt-category-strings
11296 You can modify the category component of the caption by customizing the
11297 variable @code{org-export-odt-category-strings}. For example, to tag all
11298 embedded images with the string @samp{Illustration} (instead of the default
11299 @samp{Figure}) use the following setting.
11302 (setq org-export-odt-category-strings
11303 '(("en" "Table" "Illustration" "Equation" "Equation")))
11306 With this, previous image will be captioned as below in the exported
11310 Illustration 2: Bell curve
11313 @node Literal examples in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11314 @subsection Literal examples in ODT export
11316 Export of literal examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) with full fontification
11317 is supported. Internally, the exporter relies on @file{htmlfontify.el} to
11318 generate all style definitions needed for a fancy listing.@footnote{Your
11319 @file{htmlfontify.el} library must at least be at Emacs 24.1 levels for
11320 fontification to be turned on.} The auto-generated styles have @samp{OrgSrc}
11321 as prefix and inherit their color from the faces used by Emacs
11322 @code{font-lock} library for the source language.
11324 @vindex org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks
11325 If you prefer to use your own custom styles for fontification, you can do so
11326 by customizing the variable
11327 @code{org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks}.
11329 @vindex org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks
11330 You can turn off fontification of literal examples by customizing the
11331 variable @code{org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks}.
11333 @node Advanced topics in ODT export, , Literal examples in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11334 @subsection Advanced topics in ODT export
11336 If you rely heavily on ODT export, you may want to exploit the full
11337 set of features that the exporter offers. This section describes features
11338 that would be of interest to power users.
11341 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
11342 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
11343 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
11344 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
11345 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
11348 @node Configuring a document converter, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
11349 @subsubsection Configuring a document converter
11351 @cindex doc, docx, rtf
11354 The ODT exporter can work with popular converters with little or no
11355 extra configuration from your side. @xref{Extending ODT export}.
11356 If you are using a converter that is not supported by default or if you would
11357 like to tweak the default converter settings, proceed as below.
11360 @item Register the converter
11362 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-processes
11363 Name your converter and add it to the list of known converters by customizing
11364 the variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-processes}. Also specify how the
11365 converter can be invoked via command-line to effect the conversion.
11367 @item Configure its capabilities
11369 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-capabilities
11370 @anchor{x-odt-converter-capabilities}
11371 Specify the set of formats the converter can handle by customizing the
11372 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-capabilities}. Use the default value
11373 for this variable as a guide for configuring your converter. As suggested by
11374 the default setting, you can specify the full set of formats supported by the
11375 converter and not limit yourself to specifying formats that are related to
11376 just the OpenDocument Text format.
11378 @item Choose the converter
11380 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-process
11381 Select the newly added converter as the preferred one by customizing the
11382 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-process}.
11385 @node Working with OpenDocument style files, Creating one-off styles, Configuring a document converter, Advanced topics in ODT export
11386 @subsubsection Working with OpenDocument style files
11387 @cindex styles, custom
11388 @cindex template, custom
11390 This section explores the internals of the ODT exporter and the
11391 means by which it produces styled documents. Read this section if you are
11392 interested in exploring the automatic and custom OpenDocument styles used by
11395 @anchor{x-factory-styles}
11396 @subsubheading Factory styles
11398 The ODT exporter relies on two files for generating its output.
11399 These files are bundled with the distribution under the directory pointed to
11400 by the variable @code{org-odt-styles-dir}. The two files are:
11403 @anchor{x-orgodtstyles-xml}
11405 @file{OrgOdtStyles.xml}
11407 This file contributes to the @file{styles.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11408 document. This file gets modified for the following purposes:
11412 To control outline numbering based on user settings.
11415 To add styles generated by @file{htmlfontify.el} for fontification of code
11419 @anchor{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml}
11421 @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11423 This file contributes to the @file{content.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11424 document. The contents of the Org outline are inserted between the
11425 @samp{<office:text>}@dots{}@samp{</office:text>} elements of this file.
11427 Apart from serving as a template file for the final @file{content.xml}, the
11428 file serves the following purposes:
11432 It contains automatic styles for formatting of tables which are referenced by
11436 It contains @samp{<text:sequence-decl>}@dots{}@samp{</text:sequence-decl>}
11437 elements that control how various entities - tables, images, equations etc -
11442 @anchor{x-overriding-factory-styles}
11443 @subsubheading Overriding factory styles
11444 The following two variables control the location from which the ODT
11445 exporter picks up the custom styles and content template files. You can
11446 customize these variables to override the factory styles used by the
11450 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-styles-file}
11452 @code{org-export-odt-styles-file}
11454 Use this variable to specify the @file{styles.xml} that will be used in the
11455 final output. You can specify one of the following values:
11458 @item A @file{styles.xml} file
11460 Use this file instead of the default @file{styles.xml}
11462 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file
11464 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11467 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file and a subset of files contained within them
11469 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11470 Template file. Additionally extract the specified member files and embed
11471 those within the final @samp{ODT} document.
11473 Use this option if the @file{styles.xml} file references additional files
11474 like header and footer images.
11478 Use the default @file{styles.xml}
11481 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11483 @code{org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11485 Use this variable to specify the blank @file{content.xml} that will be used
11486 in the final output.
11489 @node Creating one-off styles, Customizing tables in ODT export, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export
11490 @subsubsection Creating one-off styles
11492 There are times when you would want one-off formatting in the exported
11493 document. You can achieve this by embedding raw OpenDocument XML in the Org
11494 file. The use of this feature is better illustrated with couple of examples.
11497 @item Embedding ODT tags as part of regular text
11499 You can include simple OpenDocument tags by prefixing them with
11500 @samp{@@}. For example, to highlight a region of text do the following:
11503 @@<text:span text:style-name="Highlight">This is a
11504 highlighted text@@</text:span>. But this is a
11508 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11509 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11510 custom @samp{Highlight} style as shown below.
11513 <style:style style:name="Highlight" style:family="text">
11514 <style:text-properties fo:background-color="#ff0000"/>
11518 @item Embedding a one-line OpenDocument XML
11520 You can add a simple OpenDocument one-liner using the @code{#+ODT:}
11521 directive. For example, to force a page break do the following:
11524 #+ODT: <text:p text:style-name="PageBreak"/>
11527 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11528 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11529 custom @samp{PageBreak} style as shown below.
11532 <style:style style:name="PageBreak" style:family="paragraph"
11533 style:parent-style-name="Text_20_body">
11534 <style:paragraph-properties fo:break-before="page"/>
11538 @item Embedding a block of OpenDocument XML
11540 You can add a large block of OpenDocument XML using the
11541 @code{#+BEGIN_ODT}@dots{}@code{#+END_ODT} construct.
11543 For example, to create a one-off paragraph that uses bold text, do the
11548 <text:p text:style-name="Text_20_body_20_bold">
11549 This paragraph is specially formatted and uses bold text.
11556 @node Customizing tables in ODT export, Validating OpenDocument XML, Creating one-off styles, Advanced topics in ODT export
11557 @subsubsection Customizing tables in ODT export
11558 @cindex tables, in ODT export
11561 You can override the default formatting of the table by specifying a custom
11562 table style with the @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. For a discussion on default
11563 formatting of tables @pxref{Tables in ODT export}.
11565 This feature closely mimics the way table templates are defined in the
11567 specification.@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
11568 OpenDocument-v1.2 Specification}}
11572 @subsubheading Custom table styles - an illustration
11574 To have a quick preview of this feature, install the below setting and export
11575 the table that follows.
11578 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11579 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11580 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11581 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11582 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11583 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11584 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11585 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
11589 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
11590 | Name | Phone | Age |
11591 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
11592 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
11595 In the above example, you used a template named @samp{Custom} and installed
11596 two table styles with the names @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and
11597 @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}. (@strong{Important:} The OpenDocument
11598 styles needed for producing the above template have been pre-defined for you.
11599 These styles are available under the section marked @samp{Custom Table
11600 Template} in @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11601 (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory styles}). If you need
11602 additional templates you have to define these styles yourselves.
11604 @subsubheading Custom table styles - the nitty-gritty
11605 To use this feature proceed as follows:
11609 Create a table template@footnote{See the @code{<table:table-template>}
11610 element of the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11612 A table template is nothing but a set of @samp{table-cell} and
11613 @samp{paragraph} styles for each of the following table cell categories:
11627 The names for the above styles must be chosen based on the name of the table
11628 template using a well-defined convention.
11630 The naming convention is better illustrated with an example. For a table
11631 template with the name @samp{Custom}, the needed style names are listed in
11632 the following table.
11634 @multitable {Table cell type} {CustomEvenColumnTableCell} {CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11635 @headitem Table cell type
11636 @tab @code{table-cell} style
11637 @tab @code{paragraph} style
11642 @tab @samp{CustomTableCell}
11643 @tab @samp{CustomTableParagraph}
11645 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableCell}
11646 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableParagraph}
11648 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableCell}
11649 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableParagraph}
11651 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableCell}
11652 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableParagraph}
11654 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableCell}
11655 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableParagraph}
11657 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableCell}
11658 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableParagraph}
11660 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableCell}
11661 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableParagraph}
11663 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableCell}
11664 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11666 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableCell}
11667 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableParagraph}
11670 To create a table template with the name @samp{Custom}, define the above
11672 @code{<office:automatic-styles>}...@code{</office:automatic-styles>} element
11673 of the content template file (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory
11677 Define a table style@footnote{See the attributes @code{table:template-name},
11678 @code{table:use-first-row-styles}, @code{table:use-last-row-styles},
11679 @code{table:use-first-column-styles}, @code{table:use-last-column-styles},
11680 @code{table:use-banding-rows-styles}, and
11681 @code{table:use-banding-column-styles} of the @code{<table:table>} element in
11682 the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11684 @vindex org-export-odt-table-styles
11685 To define a table style, create an entry for the style in the variable
11686 @code{org-export-odt-table-styles} and specify the following:
11689 @item the name of the table template created in step (1)
11690 @item the set of cell styles in that template that are to be activated
11693 For example, the entry below defines two different table styles
11694 @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}
11695 based on the same template @samp{Custom}. The styles achieve their intended
11696 effect by selectively activating the individual cell styles in that template.
11699 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11700 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11701 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11702 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11703 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11704 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11705 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11706 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
11710 Associate a table with the table style
11712 To do this, specify the table style created in step (2) as part of
11713 the @code{ATTR_ODT} line as shown below.
11716 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
11717 | Name | Phone | Age |
11718 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
11719 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
11723 @node Validating OpenDocument XML, , Customizing tables in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
11724 @subsubsection Validating OpenDocument XML
11726 Occasionally, you will discover that the document created by the
11727 ODT exporter cannot be opened by your favorite application. One of
11728 the common reasons for this is that the @file{.odt} file is corrupt. In such
11729 cases, you may want to validate the document against the OpenDocument RELAX
11730 NG Compact Syntax (RNC) schema.
11732 For de-compressing the @file{.odt} file@footnote{@file{.odt} files are
11733 nothing but @samp{zip} archives}: @inforef{File Archives,,emacs}. For
11734 general help with validation (and schema-sensitive editing) of XML files:
11735 @inforef{Introduction,,nxml-mode}.
11737 @vindex org-export-odt-schema-dir
11738 If you have ready access to OpenDocument @file{.rnc} files and the needed
11739 schema-locating rules in a single folder, you can customize the variable
11740 @code{org-export-odt-schema-dir} to point to that directory. The
11741 ODT exporter will take care of updating the
11742 @code{rng-schema-locating-files} for you.
11744 @c end opendocument
11746 @node TaskJuggler export, Freemind export, OpenDocument Text export, Exporting
11747 @section TaskJuggler export
11748 @cindex TaskJuggler export
11749 @cindex Project management
11751 @uref{http://www.taskjuggler.org/, TaskJuggler} is a project management tool.
11752 It provides an optimizing scheduler that computes your project time lines and
11753 resource assignments based on the project outline and the constraints that
11756 The TaskJuggler exporter is a bit different from other exporters, such as the
11757 @code{HTML} and @LaTeX{} exporters for example, in that it does not export all the
11758 nodes of a document or strictly follow the order of the nodes in the
11761 Instead the TaskJuggler exporter looks for a tree that defines the tasks and
11762 a optionally tree that defines the resources for this project. It then
11763 creates a TaskJuggler file based on these trees and the attributes defined in
11766 @subsection TaskJuggler export commands
11769 @orgcmd{C-c C-e j,org-export-as-taskjuggler}
11770 Export as TaskJuggler file.
11772 @orgcmd{C-c C-e J,org-export-as-taskjuggler-and-open}
11773 Export as TaskJuggler file and then open the file with TaskJugglerUI.
11778 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag
11779 Create your tasks as you usually do with Org mode. Assign efforts to each
11780 task using properties (it is easiest to do this in the column view). You
11781 should end up with something similar to the example by Peter Jones in
11782 @url{http://www.contextualdevelopment.com/static/artifacts/articles/2008/project-planning/project-planning.org}.
11783 Now mark the top node of your tasks with a tag named
11784 @code{:taskjuggler_project:} (or whatever you customized
11785 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag} to). You are now ready to export
11786 the project plan with @kbd{C-c C-e J} which will export the project plan and
11787 open a gantt chart in TaskJugglerUI.
11789 @subsection Resources
11791 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag
11792 Next you can define resources and assign those to work on specific tasks. You
11793 can group your resources hierarchically. Tag the top node of the resources
11794 with @code{:taskjuggler_resource:} (or whatever you customized
11795 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag} to). You can optionally assign an
11796 identifier (named @samp{resource_id}) to the resources (using the standard
11797 Org properties commands, @pxref{Property syntax}) or you can let the exporter
11798 generate identifiers automatically (the exporter picks the first word of the
11799 headline as the identifier as long as it is unique---see the documentation of
11800 @code{org-taskjuggler-get-unique-id}). Using that identifier you can then
11801 allocate resources to tasks. This is again done with the @samp{allocate}
11802 property on the tasks. Do this in column view or when on the task type
11803 @kbd{C-c C-x p allocate @key{RET} <resource_id> @key{RET}}.
11805 Once the allocations are done you can again export to TaskJuggler and check
11806 in the Resource Allocation Graph which person is working on what task at what
11809 @subsection Export of properties
11811 The exporter also takes TODO state information into consideration, i.e.@: if a
11812 task is marked as done it will have the corresponding attribute in
11813 TaskJuggler (@samp{complete 100}). Also it will export any property on a task
11814 resource or resource node which is known to TaskJuggler, such as
11815 @samp{limits}, @samp{vacation}, @samp{shift}, @samp{booking},
11816 @samp{efficiency}, @samp{journalentry}, @samp{rate} for resources or
11817 @samp{account}, @samp{start}, @samp{note}, @samp{duration}, @samp{end},
11818 @samp{journalentry}, @samp{milestone}, @samp{reference}, @samp{responsible},
11819 @samp{scheduling}, etc for tasks.
11821 @subsection Dependencies
11823 The exporter will handle dependencies that are defined in the tasks either
11824 with the @samp{ORDERED} attribute (@pxref{TODO dependencies}), with the
11825 @samp{BLOCKER} attribute (see @file{org-depend.el}) or alternatively with a
11826 @samp{depends} attribute. Both the @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends}
11827 attribute can be either @samp{previous-sibling} or a reference to an
11828 identifier (named @samp{task_id}) which is defined for another task in the
11829 project. @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends} attribute can define multiple
11830 dependencies separated by either space or comma. You can also specify
11831 optional attributes on the dependency by simply appending it. The following
11832 examples should illustrate this:
11837 :task_id: preparation
11840 * Training material
11842 :task_id: training_material
11845 ** Markup Guidelines
11849 ** Workflow Guidelines
11856 :BLOCKER: training_material @{ gapduration 1d @} preparation
11860 @subsection Reports
11862 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports
11863 TaskJuggler can produce many kinds of reports (e.g.@: gantt chart, resource
11864 allocation, etc). The user defines what kind of reports should be generated
11865 for a project in the TaskJuggler file. The exporter will automatically insert
11866 some default reports in the file. These defaults are defined in
11867 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports}. They can be modified using
11868 customize along with a number of other options. For a more complete list, see
11869 @kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} org-export-taskjuggler @key{RET}}.
11871 For more information and examples see the Org-taskjuggler tutorial at
11872 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-taskjuggler.html}.
11874 @node Freemind export, XOXO export, TaskJuggler export, Exporting
11875 @section Freemind export
11876 @cindex Freemind export
11879 The Freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
11882 @orgcmd{C-c C-e m,org-export-as-freemind}
11883 Export as Freemind mind map. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the Freemind
11884 file will be @file{myfile.mm}.
11887 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
11888 @section XOXO export
11889 @cindex XOXO export
11891 Org mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
11892 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
11893 does not interpret any additional Org mode features.
11896 @orgcmd{C-c C-e x,org-export-as-xoxo}
11897 Export as XOXO file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the XOXO file will be
11898 @file{myfile.html}.
11899 @orgkey{C-c C-e v x}
11900 Export only the visible part of the document.
11903 @node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
11904 @section iCalendar export
11905 @cindex iCalendar export
11907 @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
11908 @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
11909 @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
11910 @vindex org-icalendar-categories
11911 @vindex org-icalendar-alarm-time
11912 Some people use Org mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
11913 standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
11914 case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
11915 files in the calendar application. Org mode can export calendar information
11916 in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
11917 included in the export, configure the variable
11918 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
11919 and TODO items as VTODO. It will also create events from deadlines that are
11920 in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
11921 to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
11922 @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
11923 As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
11924 file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
11925 configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}. See the variable
11926 @code{org-icalendar-alarm-time} for a way to assign alarms to entries with a
11929 @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
11930 @cindex property, ID
11931 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
11932 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
11933 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
11934 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
11935 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
11936 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
11937 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
11938 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
11939 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
11942 @orgcmd{C-c C-e i,org-export-icalendar-this-file}
11943 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
11944 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
11945 @orgcmd{C-c C-e I, org-export-icalendar-all-agenda-files}
11946 @vindex org-agenda-files
11947 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
11948 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
11949 file will be written.
11950 @orgcmd{C-c C-e c,org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files}
11951 @vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
11952 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
11953 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
11954 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
11957 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
11958 @vindex org-icalendar-include-body
11959 @cindex property, SUMMARY
11960 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
11961 @cindex property, LOCATION
11962 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
11963 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
11964 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
11965 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
11966 and the description from the body (limited to
11967 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
11969 How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
11970 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
11972 @node Publishing, Working With Source Code, Exporting, Top
11973 @chapter Publishing
11976 Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
11977 automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
11978 files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
11979 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
11982 You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
11983 conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
11985 Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
11988 * Configuration:: Defining projects
11989 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
11990 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
11991 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
11994 @node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
11995 @section Configuration
11997 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
11998 and many other properties of a project.
12001 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
12002 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
12003 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
12004 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
12005 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
12006 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
12007 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
12008 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
12011 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
12012 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
12013 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
12014 @cindex projects, for publishing
12016 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
12017 Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
12018 variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
12019 configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
12022 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
12023 @r{i.e.@: a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values}
12025 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
12029 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
12030 project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
12031 publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
12032 takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
12033 @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
12034 together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
12035 a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
12038 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
12039 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
12040 @cindex directories, for publishing
12042 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
12043 particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
12044 and where to put published files.
12046 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12047 @item @code{:base-directory}
12048 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
12049 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
12050 @tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
12051 publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
12052 the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
12053 use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
12054 @item @code{:preparation-function}
12055 @tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
12056 publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
12057 published. The project property list is scoped into this call as the
12058 variable @code{project-plist}.
12059 @item @code{:completion-function}
12060 @tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
12061 process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. The
12062 project property list is scoped into this call as the variable
12063 @code{project-plist}.
12067 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
12068 @subsection Selecting files
12069 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
12071 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
12072 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
12074 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12075 @item @code{:base-extension}
12076 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
12077 regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
12078 files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
12080 @item @code{:exclude}
12081 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
12082 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
12085 @item @code{:include}
12086 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
12087 and @code{:exclude}.
12089 @item @code{:recursive}
12090 @tab Non-nil means, check base-directory recursively for files to publish.
12093 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
12094 @subsection Publishing action
12095 @cindex action, for publishing
12097 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
12098 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
12099 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
12100 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
12101 export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
12102 @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}, or as @code{ascii}, @code{latin1} or
12103 @code{utf8} encoded files using the corresponding functions. If you want to
12104 publish the Org file itself, but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and
12105 @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use @code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the
12106 parameters @code{:plain-source} and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will
12107 produce @file{file.org} and @file{file.org.html} in the publishing
12108 directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
12109 source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
12110 setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
12111 definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to prevent the published
12112 source files from being considered as new org files the next time the project
12113 is published.}. Other files like images only need to be copied to the
12114 publishing destination; for this you may use @code{org-publish-attachment}.
12115 For non-Org files, you always need to specify the publishing function:
12117 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12118 @item @code{:publishing-function}
12119 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
12120 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
12121 @item @code{:plain-source}
12122 @tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
12123 @item @code{:htmlized-source}
12124 @tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
12127 The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
12128 a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be
12129 published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It
12130 should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any)
12131 and place the result into the destination folder.
12133 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
12134 @subsection Options for the HTML/@LaTeX{} exporters
12135 @cindex options, for publishing
12137 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
12138 and @LaTeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
12139 variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
12140 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
12141 respective variable for details.
12143 @vindex org-export-html-link-up
12144 @vindex org-export-html-link-home
12145 @vindex org-export-default-language
12146 @vindex org-display-custom-times
12147 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
12148 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
12149 @vindex org-export-section-number-format
12150 @vindex org-export-with-toc
12151 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
12152 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
12153 @vindex org-export-with-emphasize
12154 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
12155 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
12156 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
12157 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
12158 @vindex org-export-with-tags
12159 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
12160 @vindex org-export-with-tasks
12161 @vindex org-export-with-done-tasks
12162 @vindex org-export-with-priority
12163 @vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
12164 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
12165 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
12166 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
12167 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
12168 @vindex org-export-author-info
12169 @vindex org-export-email-info
12170 @vindex org-export-creator-info
12171 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
12172 @vindex org-export-with-tables
12173 @vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
12174 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
12175 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-scripts
12176 @vindex org-export-html-style
12177 @vindex org-export-html-style-extra
12178 @vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
12179 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
12180 @vindex org-export-html-extension
12181 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
12182 @vindex org-export-html-expand
12183 @vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
12184 @vindex org-export-publishing-directory
12185 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
12186 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
12187 @vindex user-full-name
12188 @vindex user-mail-address
12189 @vindex org-export-select-tags
12190 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
12192 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
12193 @item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
12194 @item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
12195 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
12196 @item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
12197 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
12198 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
12199 @item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
12200 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
12201 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
12202 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
12203 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
12204 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
12205 @item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
12206 @item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
12207 @item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
12208 @item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
12209 @item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
12210 @item @code{:tasks} @tab @code{org-export-with-tasks}
12211 @item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
12212 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
12213 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
12214 @item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
12215 @item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
12216 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
12217 @item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
12218 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
12219 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
12220 @item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
12221 @item @code{:email-info} @tab @code{org-export-email-info}
12222 @item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
12223 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
12224 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
12225 @item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
12226 @item @code{:style-include-scripts} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-scripts}
12227 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
12228 @item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
12229 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
12230 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
12231 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
12232 @item @code{:html-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
12233 @item @code{:html-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
12234 @item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
12235 @item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
12236 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
12237 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
12238 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
12239 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
12240 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
12241 @item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
12244 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
12245 both HTML and @LaTeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
12246 @code{:LaTeX-fragments} options, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
12247 @LaTeX{} export. See @code{org-export-plist-vars} to check this list of
12252 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
12253 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
12254 its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
12255 any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
12256 options}), however, override everything.
12258 @node Publishing links, Sitemap, Publishing options, Configuration
12259 @subsection Links between published files
12260 @cindex links, publishing
12262 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
12263 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
12264 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
12265 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
12266 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
12267 you publish them to HTML. If you also publish the Org source file and want
12268 to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
12269 because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
12272 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
12273 with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
12274 the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
12275 an example of this usage.
12277 Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
12278 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
12279 location. In this case, use the property
12281 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
12282 @item @code{:link-validation-function}
12283 @tab Function to validate links
12287 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
12288 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
12289 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
12290 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
12291 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
12292 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
12293 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
12295 @node Sitemap, Generating an index, Publishing links, Configuration
12296 @subsection Generating a sitemap
12297 @cindex sitemap, of published pages
12299 The following properties may be used to control publishing of
12300 a map of files for a given project.
12302 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
12303 @item @code{:auto-sitemap}
12304 @tab When non-nil, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
12305 or @code{org-publish-all}.
12307 @item @code{:sitemap-filename}
12308 @tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
12309 becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
12311 @item @code{:sitemap-title}
12312 @tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
12314 @item @code{:sitemap-function}
12315 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap.
12316 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-sitemap}, which generates a plain list
12317 of links to all files in the project.
12319 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
12320 @tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
12321 (default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last,
12322 respectively. Any other value will mix files and folders.
12324 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-files}
12325 @tab How the files are sorted in the site map. Set this to
12326 @code{alphabetically} (default), @code{chronologically} or
12327 @code{anti-chronologically}. @code{chronologically} sorts the files with
12328 older date first while @code{anti-chronologically} sorts the files with newer
12329 date first. @code{alphabetically} sorts the files alphabetically. The date of
12330 a file is retrieved with @code{org-publish-find-date}.
12332 @item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
12333 @tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
12335 @item @code{:sitemap-file-entry-format}
12336 @tab With this option one can tell how a sitemap's entry is formatted in the
12337 sitemap. This is a format string with some escape sequences: @code{%t} stands
12338 for the title of the file, @code{%a} stands for the author of the file and
12339 @code{%d} stands for the date of the file. The date is retrieved with the
12340 @code{org-publish-find-date} function and formatted with
12341 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format}. Default @code{%t}.
12343 @item @code{:sitemap-date-format}
12344 @tab Format string for the @code{format-time-string} function that tells how
12345 a sitemap entry's date is to be formatted. This property bypasses
12346 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format} which defaults to @code{%Y-%m-%d}.
12348 @item @code{:sitemap-sans-extension}
12349 @tab When non-nil, remove filenames' extensions from the generated sitemap.
12350 Useful to have cool URIs (see @uref{http://www.w3.org/Provider/Style/URI}).
12351 Defaults to @code{nil}.
12355 @node Generating an index, , Sitemap, Configuration
12356 @subsection Generating an index
12357 @cindex index, in a publishing project
12359 Org mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
12361 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12362 @item @code{:makeindex}
12363 @tab When non-nil, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
12364 publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
12367 The file will be created when first publishing a project with the
12368 @code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+INCLUDE:
12369 "theindex.inc"}. You can then build around this include statement by adding
12370 a title, style information, etc.
12372 @node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
12373 @section Uploading files
12377 For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
12378 @command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
12379 @i{remote} publishing facilities of Org mode which rely heavily on
12380 Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
12381 so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
12384 Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
12385 to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
12386 checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
12387 directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
12388 @file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
12390 Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
12391 a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
12392 definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
12393 files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
12394 You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
12395 @file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
12398 Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
12399 that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
12400 @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
12401 benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
12402 files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE}. The timestamp mechanism in
12403 Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
12405 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
12406 @section Sample configuration
12408 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
12409 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
12410 more complex, with a multi-component project.
12413 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
12414 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
12417 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
12418 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
12420 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
12421 directory on the local machine.
12424 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12426 :base-directory "~/org/"
12427 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
12428 :section-numbers nil
12429 :table-of-contents nil
12430 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12431 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
12432 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
12435 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
12436 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
12438 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
12439 Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
12440 style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
12443 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
12444 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
12445 paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
12446 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
12449 file:../images/myimage.png
12452 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
12453 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
12454 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
12457 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12459 :base-directory "~/org/"
12460 :base-extension "org"
12461 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
12462 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
12463 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
12465 :section-numbers nil
12466 :table-of-contents nil
12467 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12468 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
12472 :base-directory "~/images/"
12473 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
12474 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
12475 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12478 :base-directory "~/other/"
12479 :base-extension "css\\|el"
12480 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
12481 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12482 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
12485 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
12486 @section Triggering publication
12488 Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
12491 @orgcmd{C-c C-e X,org-publish}
12492 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
12493 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P,org-publish-current-project}
12494 Publish the project containing the current file.
12495 @orgcmd{C-c C-e F,org-publish-current-file}
12496 Publish only the current file.
12497 @orgcmd{C-c C-e E,org-publish-all}
12498 Publish every project.
12501 @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
12502 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
12503 normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
12504 publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
12505 above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
12506 This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
12507 @code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
12509 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12510 @comment Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12512 @node Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12513 @chapter Working with source code
12514 @cindex Schulte, Eric
12515 @cindex Davison, Dan
12516 @cindex source code, working with
12518 Source code can be included in Org mode documents using a @samp{src} block,
12522 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
12523 (defun org-xor (a b)
12529 Org mode provides a number of features for working with live source code,
12530 including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode, evaluation of
12531 code blocks, converting code blocks into source files (known as @dfn{tangling}
12532 in literate programming), and exporting code blocks and their
12533 results in several formats. This functionality was contributed by Eric
12534 Schulte and Dan Davison, and was originally named Org-babel.
12536 The following sections describe Org mode's code block handling facilities.
12539 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
12540 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
12541 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
12542 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
12543 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
12544 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
12545 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
12546 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
12547 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
12548 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
12549 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
12550 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
12553 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12554 @comment Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12556 @node Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12557 @section Structure of code blocks
12558 @cindex code block, structure
12559 @cindex source code, block structure
12561 @cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
12563 Live code blocks can be specified with a @samp{src} block or
12564 inline.@footnote{Note that @samp{src} blocks may be inserted using Org mode's
12565 @ref{Easy Templates} system} The structure of a @samp{src} block is
12569 #+BEGIN_SRC <language> <switches> <header arguments>
12574 The @code{#+NAME:} line is optional, and can be used to name the code
12575 block. Live code blocks require that a language be specified on the
12576 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line. Switches and header arguments are optional.
12577 @cindex source code, inline
12579 Live code blocks can also be specified inline using
12582 src_<language>@{<body>@}
12588 src_<language>[<header arguments>]@{<body>@}
12592 @item <#+NAME: name>
12593 This line associates a name with the code block. This is similar to the
12594 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} lines that can be used to name tables in Org mode
12595 files. Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to evaluate
12596 the block from other places in the file, from other files, or from Org mode
12597 table formulas (see @ref{The spreadsheet}). Names are assumed to be unique
12598 and the behavior of Org mode when two or more blocks share the same name is
12602 The language of the code in the block (see @ref{Languages}).
12603 @cindex source code, language
12605 Optional switches control code block export (see the discussion of switches in
12606 @ref{Literal examples})
12607 @cindex source code, switches
12608 @item <header arguments>
12609 Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
12610 tangling of code blocks (see @ref{Header arguments}).
12611 Header arguments can also be set on a per-buffer or per-subtree
12612 basis using properties.
12613 @item source code, header arguments
12615 Source code in the specified language.
12618 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12619 @comment Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12621 @node Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12622 @section Editing source code
12623 @cindex code block, editing
12624 @cindex source code, editing
12627 Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. This brings up
12628 a language major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code
12629 block. Saving this buffer will write the new contents back to the Org
12630 buffer. Use @kbd{C-c '} again to exit.
12632 The @code{org-src-mode} minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
12633 following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
12634 buffer. See also the customization group @code{org-edit-structure} for
12635 further configuration options.
12638 @item org-src-lang-modes
12639 If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where
12640 @code{<lang>} is the language named in the header line of the code block,
12641 then the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
12642 can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major modes.
12643 @item org-src-window-setup
12644 Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer is created.
12645 @item org-src-preserve-indentation
12646 This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
12647 Python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
12648 @item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
12649 By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer. Set this
12650 variable to nil to switch without asking.
12653 To turn on native code fontification in the @emph{Org} buffer, configure the
12654 variable @code{org-src-fontify-natively}.
12656 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12657 @comment Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12659 @node Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12660 @section Exporting code blocks
12661 @cindex code block, exporting
12662 @cindex source code, exporting
12664 It is possible to export the @emph{code} of code blocks, the @emph{results}
12665 of code block evaluation, @emph{both} the code and the results of code block
12666 evaluation, or @emph{none}. For most languages, the default exports code.
12667 However, for some languages (e.g.@: @code{ditaa}) the default exports the
12668 results of code block evaluation. For information on exporting code block
12669 bodies, see @ref{Literal examples}.
12671 The @code{:exports} header argument can be used to specify export
12674 @subsubheading Header arguments:
12676 @item :exports code
12677 The default in most languages. The body of the code block is exported, as
12678 described in @ref{Literal examples}.
12679 @item :exports results
12680 The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in the
12681 Org mode buffer for export, either updating previous results of the code
12682 block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no previous results exist,
12683 placing the results immediately after the code block. The body of the code
12684 block will not be exported.
12685 @item :exports both
12686 Both the code block and its results will be exported.
12687 @item :exports none
12688 Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
12691 It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during export.
12692 Setting the @code{org-export-babel-evaluate} variable to @code{nil} will
12693 ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process. This
12694 can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org mode files are
12695 exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org mode is used as the
12696 markup language for a wiki.
12698 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12699 @comment Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
12700 @node Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
12701 @section Extracting source code
12703 @cindex source code, extracting
12704 @cindex code block, extracting source code
12706 Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
12707 referred to as ``tangling''---a term adopted from the literate programming
12708 community. During ``tangling'' of code blocks their bodies are expanded
12709 using @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} which can expand both variable and
12710 ``noweb'' style references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}).
12712 @subsubheading Header arguments
12715 The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
12717 Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name is the
12718 name of the org file with the extension @samp{.org} replaced by the extension
12719 for the block language.
12720 @item :tangle filename
12721 Include the code block in the tangled output to file @samp{filename}.
12725 @subsubheading Functions
12727 @item org-babel-tangle
12728 Tangle the current file. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v t}.
12729 @item org-babel-tangle-file
12730 Choose a file to tangle. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v f}.
12733 @subsubheading Hooks
12735 @item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
12736 This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}.
12737 Example applications could include post-processing, compilation or evaluation
12738 of tangled code files.
12741 @node Evaluating code blocks, Library of Babel, Extracting source code, Working With Source Code
12742 @section Evaluating code blocks
12743 @cindex code block, evaluating
12744 @cindex source code, evaluating
12747 Code blocks can be evaluated@footnote{Whenever code is evaluated there is a
12748 potential for that code to do harm. Org mode provides safeguards to ensure
12749 that code is only evaluated after explicit confirmation from the user. For
12750 information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see @ref{Code
12751 evaluation security}.} and the results of evaluation optionally placed in the
12752 Org mode buffer. The results of evaluation are placed following a line that
12753 begins by default with @code{#+RESULTS} and optionally a cache identifier
12754 and/or the name of the evaluated code block. The default value of
12755 @code{#+RESULTS} can be changed with the customizable variable
12756 @code{org-babel-results-keyword}.
12758 By default, the evaluation facility is only enabled for Lisp code blocks
12759 specified as @code{emacs-lisp}. However, source code blocks in many languages
12760 can be evaluated within Org mode (see @ref{Languages} for a list of supported
12761 languages and @ref{Structure of code blocks} for information on the syntax
12762 used to define a code block).
12765 There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is to press
12766 @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The
12767 @code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} variable can be used to remove code
12768 evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.}. This will call the
12769 @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function to evaluate the block and insert
12770 its results into the Org mode buffer.
12773 It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an Org
12774 mode buffer or an Org mode table. Live code blocks located in the current
12775 Org mode buffer or in the ``Library of Babel'' (see @ref{Library of Babel})
12776 can be executed. Named code blocks can be executed with a separate
12777 @code{#+CALL:} line or inline within a block of text.
12779 The syntax of the @code{#+CALL:} line is
12782 #+CALL: <name>(<arguments>)
12783 #+CALL: <name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>) <end header arguments>
12786 The syntax for inline evaluation of named code blocks is
12789 ... call_<name>(<arguments>) ...
12790 ... call_<name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>)[<end header arguments>] ...
12795 The name of the code block to be evaluated (see @ref{Structure of code blocks}).
12797 Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code block. These
12798 arguments use standard function call syntax, rather than
12799 header argument syntax. For example, a @code{#+CALL:} line that passes the
12800 number four to a code block named @code{double}, which declares the header
12801 argument @code{:var n=2}, would be written as @code{#+CALL: double(n=4)}.
12802 @item <inside header arguments>
12803 Inside header arguments are passed through and applied to the named code
12804 block. These arguments use header argument syntax rather than standard
12805 function call syntax. Inside header arguments affect how the code block is
12806 evaluated. For example, @code{[:results output]} will collect the results of
12807 everything printed to @code{STDOUT} during execution of the code block.
12808 @item <end header arguments>
12809 End header arguments are applied to the calling instance and do not affect
12810 evaluation of the named code block. They affect how the results are
12811 incorporated into the Org mode buffer and how the call line is exported. For
12812 example, @code{:results html} will insert the results of the call line
12813 evaluation in the Org buffer, wrapped in a @code{BEGIN_HTML:} block.
12815 For more examples of passing header arguments to @code{#+CALL:} lines see
12816 @ref{Header arguments in function calls}.
12819 @node Library of Babel, Languages, Evaluating code blocks, Working With Source Code
12820 @section Library of Babel
12821 @cindex babel, library of
12822 @cindex source code, library
12823 @cindex code block, library
12825 The ``Library of Babel'' consists of code blocks that can be called from any
12826 Org mode file. Code blocks defined in the ``Library of Babel'' can be called
12827 remotely as if they were in the current Org mode buffer (see @ref{Evaluating
12828 code blocks} for information on the syntax of remote code block evaluation).
12831 The central repository of code blocks in the ``Library of Babel'' is housed
12832 in an Org mode file located in the @samp{contrib} directory of Org mode.
12834 Users can add code blocks they believe to be generally useful to their
12835 ``Library of Babel.'' The code blocks can be stored in any Org mode file and
12836 then loaded into the library with @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}.
12840 Code blocks located in any Org mode file can be loaded into the ``Library of
12841 Babel'' with the @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-v
12844 @node Languages, Header arguments, Library of Babel, Working With Source Code
12846 @cindex babel, languages
12847 @cindex source code, languages
12848 @cindex code block, languages
12850 Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
12852 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.3 0.22 0.2
12853 @item @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
12854 @item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab Awk @tab awk
12855 @item Emacs Calc @tab calc @tab C @tab C
12856 @item C++ @tab C++ @tab Clojure @tab clojure
12857 @item CSS @tab css @tab ditaa @tab ditaa
12858 @item Graphviz @tab dot @tab Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp
12859 @item gnuplot @tab gnuplot @tab Haskell @tab haskell
12860 @item Java @tab java @tab @tab
12861 @item Javascript @tab js @tab LaTeX @tab latex
12862 @item Ledger @tab ledger @tab Lisp @tab lisp
12863 @item Lilypond @tab lilypond @tab MATLAB @tab matlab
12864 @item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
12865 @item Octave @tab octave @tab Org mode @tab org
12866 @item Oz @tab oz @tab Perl @tab perl
12867 @item Plantuml @tab plantuml @tab Python @tab python
12868 @item R @tab R @tab Ruby @tab ruby
12869 @item Sass @tab sass @tab Scheme @tab scheme
12870 @item GNU Screen @tab screen @tab shell @tab sh
12871 @item SQL @tab sql @tab SQLite @tab sqlite
12874 Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
12875 available, it can be found at
12876 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages}.
12878 The @code{org-babel-load-languages} controls which languages are enabled for
12879 evaluation (by default only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled). This variable can
12880 be set using the customization interface or by adding code like the following
12881 to your emacs configuration.
12884 The following disables @code{emacs-lisp} evaluation and enables evaluation of
12885 @code{R} code blocks.
12889 (org-babel-do-load-languages
12890 'org-babel-load-languages
12891 '((emacs-lisp . nil)
12895 It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the related
12896 elisp file with @code{require}.
12899 The following adds support for evaluating @code{clojure} code blocks.
12903 (require 'ob-clojure)
12906 @node Header arguments, Results of evaluation, Languages, Working With Source Code
12907 @section Header arguments
12908 @cindex code block, header arguments
12909 @cindex source code, block header arguments
12911 Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
12912 section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
12913 describes each header argument in detail.
12916 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
12917 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
12920 @node Using header arguments, Specific header arguments, Header arguments, Header arguments
12921 @subsection Using header arguments
12923 The values of header arguments can be set in six different ways, each more
12924 specific (and having higher priority) than the last.
12926 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
12927 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
12928 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
12929 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
12930 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
12931 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
12935 @node System-wide header arguments, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments, Using header arguments
12936 @subsubheading System-wide header arguments
12937 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
12938 System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing the
12939 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
12943 :results => "replace"
12950 @c org-babel-default-header-args is a variable defined in `org-babel.el'.
12952 @c ((:session . "none")
12953 @c (:results . "replace")
12954 @c (:exports . "code")
12956 @c (:noweb . "no"))
12960 @c Default arguments to use when evaluating a code block.
12963 For example, the following example could be used to set the default value of
12964 @code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}. This would have the effect of
12965 expanding @code{:noweb} references by default when evaluating source code
12969 (setq org-babel-default-header-args
12970 (cons '(:noweb . "yes")
12971 (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
12974 @node Language-specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, System-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
12975 @subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
12976 Each language can define its own set of default header arguments. See the
12977 language-specific documentation available online at
12978 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
12980 @node Buffer-wide header arguments, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments
12981 @subsubheading Buffer-wide header arguments
12982 Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified as properties through the use
12983 of @code{#+PROPERTY:} lines placed anywhere in an Org mode file (see
12984 @ref{Property syntax}).
12986 For example the following would set @code{session} to @code{*R*}, and
12987 @code{results} to @code{silent} for every code block in the buffer, ensuring
12988 that all execution took place in the same session, and no results would be
12989 inserted into the buffer.
12992 #+PROPERTY: session *R*
12993 #+PROPERTY: results silent
12996 @node Header arguments in Org mode properties, Code block specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
12997 @subsubheading Header arguments in Org mode properties
12999 Header arguments are also read from Org mode properties (see @ref{Property
13000 syntax}), which can be set on a buffer-wide or per-heading basis. An example
13001 of setting a header argument for all code blocks in a buffer is
13004 #+PROPERTY: tangle yes
13007 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
13008 When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are looked up
13009 with inheritance, regardless of the value of
13010 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. In the following example the value of
13011 the @code{:cache} header argument will default to @code{yes} in all code
13012 blocks in the subtree rooted at the following heading:
13022 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
13023 Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
13024 @code{org-babel-default-header-args}. It is convenient to use the
13025 @code{org-set-property} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p} to set properties
13026 in Org mode documents.
13028 @node Code block specific header arguments, Header arguments in function calls, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Using header arguments
13029 @subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
13031 The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the
13032 code block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
13033 arguments and their values as part of the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line.
13034 Properties set in this way override both the values of
13035 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} and header arguments specified as
13036 properties. In the following example, the @code{:results} header argument
13037 is set to @code{silent}, meaning the results of execution will not be
13038 inserted in the buffer, and the @code{:exports} header argument is set to
13039 @code{code}, meaning only the body of the code block will be
13040 preserved on export to HTML or @LaTeX{}.
13044 #+BEGIN_SRC haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
13046 fac n = n * fac (n-1)
13049 Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code blocks
13052 src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
13055 Code block header arguments can span multiple lines using @code{#+HEADER:} or
13056 @code{#+HEADERS:} lines preceding a code block or nested between the
13057 @code{#+NAME:} line and the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line of a named code block.
13061 Multi-line header arguments on an un-named code block:
13063 #+HEADERS: :var data1=1
13064 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data2=2
13065 (message "data1:%S, data2:%S" data1 data2)
13072 Multi-line header arguments on a named code block:
13074 #+NAME: named-block
13075 #+HEADER: :var data=2
13076 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13077 (message "data:%S" data)
13080 #+RESULTS: named-block
13084 @node Header arguments in function calls, , Code block specific header arguments, Using header arguments
13085 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
13086 @subsubheading Header arguments in function calls
13088 At the most specific level, header arguments for ``Library of Babel'' or
13089 @code{#+CALL:} lines can be set as shown in the two examples below. For more
13090 information on the structure of @code{#+CALL:} lines see @ref{Evaluating code
13093 The following will apply the @code{:exports results} header argument to the
13094 evaluation of the @code{#+CALL:} line.
13096 #+CALL: factorial(n=5) :exports results
13099 The following will apply the @code{:session special} header argument to the
13100 evaluation of the @code{factorial} code block.
13102 #+CALL: factorial[:session special](n=5)
13105 @node Specific header arguments, , Using header arguments, Header arguments
13106 @subsection Specific header arguments
13107 Header arguments consist of an initial colon followed by the name of the
13108 argument in lowercase letters. The following header arguments are defined:
13111 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
13112 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
13113 be collected and handled
13114 * file:: Specify a path for file output
13115 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
13116 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
13117 directory for code block execution
13118 * exports:: Export code and/or results
13119 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
13120 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
13121 files during tangling
13122 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
13124 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
13126 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
13127 expansion during tangling
13128 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
13129 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
13130 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
13131 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
13132 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
13133 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
13134 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
13135 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
13136 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
13137 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
13138 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
13139 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
13142 Additional header arguments are defined on a language-specific basis, see
13145 @node var, results, Specific header arguments, Specific header arguments
13146 @subsubsection @code{:var}
13147 The @code{:var} header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
13148 The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by language;
13149 these are addressed in the language-specific documentation. However, the
13150 syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all languages. In every
13151 case, variables require a default value when they are declared.
13153 The values passed to arguments can either be literal values, references, or
13154 Emacs Lisp code (see @ref{var, Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables}). References
13155 include anything in the Org mode file that takes a @code{#+NAME:},
13156 @code{#+TBLNAME:}, or @code{#+RESULTS:} line. This includes tables, lists,
13157 @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE} blocks, other code blocks, and the results of other
13160 Argument values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays (see @ref{var,
13161 Indexable variable values}).
13163 The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the
13164 @code{:var} header argument.
13170 The argument, @code{assign}, can either be a literal value, such as a string
13171 @samp{"string"} or a number @samp{9}, or a reference to a table, a list, a
13172 literal example, another code block (with or without arguments), or the
13173 results of evaluating another code block.
13175 Here are examples of passing values by reference:
13180 an Org mode table named with either a @code{#+NAME:} or @code{#+TBLNAME:} line
13182 #+TBLNAME: example-table
13188 #+NAME: table-length
13189 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
13193 #+RESULTS: table-length
13198 a simple list named with a @code{#+NAME:} line (note that nesting is not
13199 carried through to the source code block)
13202 #+NAME: example-list
13208 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=example-list
13216 @item code block without arguments
13217 a code block name (from the example above), as assigned by @code{#+NAME:},
13218 optionally followed by parentheses
13221 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
13229 @item code block with arguments
13230 a code block name, as assigned by @code{#+NAME:}, followed by parentheses and
13231 optional arguments passed within the parentheses following the
13232 code block name using standard function call syntax
13236 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=8
13244 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
13252 @item literal example
13253 a literal example block named with a @code{#+NAME:} line
13256 #+NAME: literal-example
13262 #+NAME: read-literal-example
13263 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=literal-example
13264 (concatenate 'string x " for you.")
13267 #+RESULTS: read-literal-example
13268 : A literal example
13269 : on two lines for you.
13275 @subsubheading Alternate argument syntax
13276 It is also possible to specify arguments in a potentially more natural way
13277 using the @code{#+NAME:} line of a code block. As in the following
13278 example, arguments can be packed inside of parentheses, separated by commas,
13279 following the source name.
13282 #+NAME: double(input=0, x=2)
13283 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13288 @subsubheading Indexable variable values
13289 It is possible to reference portions of variable values by ``indexing'' into
13290 the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting back from
13291 the end. If an index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section
13292 will index into the next deepest nesting or dimension of the value. Note
13293 that this indexing occurs @emph{before} other table related header arguments
13294 like @code{:hlines}, @code{:colnames} and @code{:rownames} are applied. The
13295 following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table
13296 @code{example-table} to the variable @code{data}:
13299 #+NAME: example-table
13305 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
13313 Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
13314 @code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
13315 example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
13319 #+NAME: example-table
13326 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
13336 Additionally, an empty index, or the single character @code{*}, are both
13337 interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
13338 @code{0:-1}, as shown in the following example in which the entire first
13339 column is referenced.
13342 #+NAME: example-table
13348 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
13356 It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as tables.
13357 Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are separated from one
13358 another by commas, as shown in the following example.
13362 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13363 '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
13364 ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
13365 ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
13368 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
13376 @subsubheading Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables
13378 Emacs lisp code can be used to initialize variable values. When a variable
13379 value starts with @code{(}, @code{[}, @code{'} or @code{`} it will be
13380 evaluated as Emacs Lisp and the result of the evaluation will be assigned as
13381 the variable value. The following example demonstrates use of this
13382 evaluation to reliably pass the file-name of the Org mode buffer to a code
13383 block---note that evaluation of header arguments is guaranteed to take place
13384 in the original Org mode file, while there is no such guarantee for
13385 evaluation of the code block body.
13388 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :var filename=(buffer-file-name) :exports both
13393 Note that values read from tables and lists will not be evaluated as
13394 Emacs Lisp, as shown in the following example.
13400 #+HEADERS: :var data=table[0,0]
13409 @node results, file, var, Specific header arguments
13410 @subsubsection @code{:results}
13412 There are three classes of @code{:results} header argument. Only one option
13413 per class may be supplied per code block.
13417 @b{collection} header arguments specify how the results should be collected
13418 from the code block
13420 @b{type} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
13421 return---which has implications for how they will be inserted into the
13424 @b{handling} header arguments specify how the results of evaluating the code
13425 block should be handled.
13428 @subsubheading Collection
13429 The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the results
13430 should be collected from the code block.
13434 This is the default. The result is the value of the last statement in the
13435 code block. This header argument places the evaluation in functional
13436 mode. Note that in some languages, e.g., Python, use of this result type
13437 requires that a @code{return} statement be included in the body of the source
13438 code block. E.g., @code{:results value}.
13439 @item @code{output}
13440 The result is the collection of everything printed to STDOUT during the
13441 execution of the code block. This header argument places the
13442 evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., @code{:results output}.
13445 @subsubheading Type
13447 The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
13448 the code block will return. By default, results are inserted as either a
13449 table or scalar depending on their value.
13452 @item @code{table}, @code{vector}
13453 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode table. If a single value is
13454 returned, it will be converted into a table with one row and one column.
13455 E.g., @code{:results value table}.
13457 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode list. If a single scalar
13458 value is returned it will be converted into a list with only one element.
13459 @item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
13460 The results should be interpreted literally---they will not be
13461 converted into a table. The results will be inserted into the Org mode
13462 buffer as quoted text. E.g., @code{:results value verbatim}.
13464 The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and will be inserted
13465 into the Org mode buffer as a file link. E.g., @code{:results value file}.
13466 @item @code{raw}, @code{org}
13467 The results are interpreted as raw Org mode code and are inserted directly
13468 into the buffer. If the results look like a table they will be aligned as
13469 such by Org mode. E.g., @code{:results value raw}.
13471 Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_HTML}
13472 block. E.g., @code{:results value html}.
13474 Results assumed to be @LaTeX{} and are enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_LaTeX} block.
13475 E.g., @code{:results value latex}.
13477 Result are assumed to be parsable code and are enclosed in a code block.
13478 E.g., @code{:results value code}.
13480 The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is enclosed in a code
13481 block. This option currently supports Emacs Lisp, Python, and Ruby. E.g.,
13482 @code{:results value pp}.
13484 The result is wrapped in a RESULTS drawer. This can be useful for
13485 inserting @code{raw} or @code{org} syntax results in such a way that their
13486 extent is known and they can be automatically removed or replaced.
13489 @subsubheading Handling
13490 The following results options indicate what happens with the
13491 results once they are collected.
13494 @item @code{silent}
13495 The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not be inserted into
13496 the Org mode buffer. E.g., @code{:results output silent}.
13497 @item @code{replace}
13498 The default value. Any existing results will be removed, and the new results
13499 will be inserted into the Org mode buffer in their place. E.g.,
13500 @code{:results output replace}.
13501 @item @code{append}
13502 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13503 be appended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13504 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13505 @item @code{prepend}
13506 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13507 be prepended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13508 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13511 @node file, file-desc, results, Specific header arguments
13512 @subsubsection @code{:file}
13514 The header argument @code{:file} is used to specify an external file in which
13515 to save code block results. After code block evaluation an Org mode style
13516 @code{[[file:]]} link (see @ref{Link format}) to the file will be inserted
13517 into the Org mode buffer. Some languages including R, gnuplot, dot, and
13518 ditaa provide special handling of the @code{:file} header argument
13519 automatically wrapping the code block body in the boilerplate code required
13520 to save output to the specified file. This is often useful for saving
13521 graphical output of a code block to the specified file.
13523 The argument to @code{:file} should be either a string specifying the path to
13524 a file, or a list of two strings in which case the first element of the list
13525 should be the path to a file and the second a description for the link.
13527 @node file-desc, dir, file, Specific header arguments
13528 @subsubsection @code{:file-desc}
13530 The value of the @code{:file-desc} header argument is used to provide a
13531 description for file code block results which are inserted as Org-mode links
13532 (see @ref{Link format}). If the @code{:file-desc} header argument is given
13533 with no value the link path will be placed in both the ``link'' and the
13534 ``description'' portion of the Org-mode link.
13536 @node dir, exports, file-desc, Specific header arguments
13537 @subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
13539 While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
13540 output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during code block
13541 execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current
13542 buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path} temporarily has
13543 the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd path}, and
13544 then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the surface, @code{:dir} simply sets
13545 the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}.
13547 When using @code{:dir}, you should supply a relative path for file output
13548 (e.g.@: @code{:file myfile.jpg} or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) in which
13549 case that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
13551 In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called @file{Work}
13552 in your home directory, you could use
13555 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
13556 matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
13560 @subsubheading Remote execution
13561 A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file syntax, in
13562 which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine. An example is
13565 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file plot.png :dir /dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
13566 plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
13570 Text results will be returned to the local Org mode buffer as usual, and file
13571 output will be created on the remote machine with relative paths interpreted
13572 relative to the remote directory. An Org mode link to the remote file will be
13575 So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote machine,
13576 and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org buffer:
13579 [[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
13582 Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that @code{:dir}
13583 sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}, thanks to
13584 tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need to
13585 install tramp separately in order for these features to work correctly.
13587 @subsubheading Further points
13591 If @code{:dir} is used in conjunction with @code{:session}, although it will
13592 determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no attempt is
13593 currently made to alter the directory associated with an existing session.
13595 @code{:dir} should typically not be used to create files during export with
13596 @code{:exports results} or @code{:exports both}. The reason is that, in order
13597 to retain portability of exported material between machines, during export
13598 links inserted into the buffer will @emph{not} be expanded against @code{default
13599 directory}. Therefore, if @code{default-directory} is altered using
13600 @code{:dir}, it is probable that the file will be created in a location to
13601 which the link does not point.
13604 @node exports, tangle, dir, Specific header arguments
13605 @subsubsection @code{:exports}
13607 The @code{:exports} header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
13608 or @LaTeX{} exports of the Org mode file.
13612 The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. E.g.,
13613 @code{:exports code}.
13614 @item @code{results}
13615 The result of evaluating the code is included in the exported file. E.g.,
13616 @code{:exports results}.
13618 Both the code and results are included in the exported file. E.g.,
13619 @code{:exports both}.
13621 Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., @code{:exports none}.
13624 @node tangle, mkdirp, exports, Specific header arguments
13625 @subsubsection @code{:tangle}
13627 The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies whether or not the code
13628 block should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
13631 @item @code{tangle}
13632 The code block is exported to a source code file named after the full path
13633 (including the directory) and file name (w/o extension) of the Org mode file.
13634 E.g., @code{:tangle yes}.
13636 The default. The code block is not exported to a source code file.
13637 E.g., @code{:tangle no}.
13639 Any other string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument is interpreted
13640 as a path (directory and file name relative to the directory of the Org mode
13641 file) to which the block will be exported. E.g., @code{:tangle path}.
13644 @node mkdirp, comments, tangle, Specific header arguments
13645 @subsubsection @code{:mkdirp}
13647 The @code{:mkdirp} header argument can be used to create parent directories
13648 of tangled files when missing. This can be set to @code{yes} to enable
13649 directory creation or to @code{no} to inhibit directory creation.
13651 @node comments, padline, mkdirp, Specific header arguments
13652 @subsubsection @code{:comments}
13653 By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any insertion
13654 of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body of the code
13655 block. The @code{:comments} header argument can be set as follows to control
13656 the insertion of extra comments into the tangled code file.
13660 The default. No extra comments are inserted during tangling.
13662 The code block is wrapped in comments which contain pointers back to the
13663 original Org file from which the code was tangled.
13665 A synonym for ``link'' to maintain backwards compatibility.
13667 Include text from the Org mode file as a comment.
13669 The text is picked from the leading context of the tangled code and is
13670 limited by the nearest headline or source block as the case may be.
13672 Turns on both the ``link'' and ``org'' comment options.
13674 Turns on the ``link'' comment option, and additionally wraps expanded noweb
13675 references in the code block body in link comments.
13678 @node padline, no-expand, comments, Specific header arguments
13679 @subsubsection @code{:padline}
13680 Control in insertion of padding lines around code block bodies in tangled
13681 code files. The default value is @code{yes} which results in insertion of
13682 newlines before and after each tangled code block. The following arguments
13687 Insert newlines before and after each code block body in tangled code files.
13689 Do not insert any newline padding in tangled output.
13692 @node no-expand, session, padline, Specific header arguments
13693 @subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
13695 By default, code blocks are expanded with @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
13696 during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
13697 specified with @code{:var} (see @ref{var}), and of replacing ``noweb''
13698 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) with their targets. The
13699 @code{:no-expand} header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
13701 @node session, noweb, no-expand, Specific header arguments
13702 @subsubsection @code{:session}
13704 The @code{:session} header argument starts a session for an interpreted
13705 language where state is preserved.
13707 By default, a session is not started.
13709 A string passed to the @code{:session} header argument will give the session
13710 a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for each
13711 interpreted language.
13713 @node noweb, noweb-ref, session, Specific header arguments
13714 @subsubsection @code{:noweb}
13716 The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of ``noweb'' syntax
13717 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) when the code block is
13718 evaluated, tangled, or exported. The @code{:noweb} header argument can have
13719 one of the five values: @code{no}, @code{yes}, @code{tangle}, or
13720 @code{no-export} @code{strip-export}.
13724 The default. ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will
13725 not be expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
13727 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
13728 expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
13729 @item @code{tangle}
13730 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13731 before the code block is tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax references will
13732 not be expanded when the code block is evaluated or exported.
13733 @item @code{no-export}
13734 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13735 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
13736 references will not be expanded when the code block is exported.
13737 @item @code{strip-export}
13738 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13739 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
13740 references will not be removed when the code block is exported.
13742 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will only be
13743 expanded before the block is evaluated.
13746 @subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
13747 Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
13748 @code{<<reference>>}.
13749 This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
13750 @code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
13751 each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
13764 -- multi-line body of example
13767 Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines will not
13768 be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use inline noweb
13771 @node noweb-ref, noweb-sep, noweb, Specific header arguments
13772 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-ref}
13773 When expanding ``noweb'' style references the bodies of all code block with
13774 @emph{either} a block name matching the reference name @emph{or} a
13775 @code{:noweb-ref} header argument matching the reference name will be
13776 concatenated together to form the replacement text.
13778 By setting this header argument at the sub-tree or file level, simple code
13779 block concatenation may be achieved. For example, when tangling the
13780 following Org mode file, the bodies of code blocks will be concatenated into
13781 the resulting pure code file@footnote{(The example needs property inheritance
13782 to be turned on for the @code{noweb-ref} property, see @ref{Property
13786 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :tangle yes :noweb yes :shebang #!/bin/sh
13789 * the mount point of the fullest disk
13791 :noweb-ref: fullest-disk
13794 ** query all mounted disks
13799 ** strip the header row
13804 ** sort by the percent full
13806 |awk '@{print $5 " " $6@}'|sort -n |tail -1 \
13809 ** extract the mount point
13811 |awk '@{print $2@}'
13815 The @code{:noweb-sep} (see @ref{noweb-sep}) header argument holds the string
13816 used to separate accumulate noweb references like those above. By default a
13819 @node noweb-sep, cache, noweb-ref, Specific header arguments
13820 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-sep}
13822 The @code{:noweb-sep} header argument holds the string used to separate
13823 accumulate noweb references (see @ref{noweb-ref}). By default a newline is
13826 @node cache, sep, noweb-sep, Specific header arguments
13827 @subsubsection @code{:cache}
13829 The @code{:cache} header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
13830 the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid re-evaluating
13831 unchanged code blocks. Note that the @code{:cache} header argument will not
13832 attempt to cache results when the @code{:session} header argument is used,
13833 because the results of the code block execution may be stored in the session
13834 outside of the Org-mode buffer. The @code{:cache} header argument can have
13835 one of two values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
13839 The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will be evaluated
13840 every time it is called.
13842 Every time the code block is run a SHA1 hash of the code and arguments
13843 passed to the block will be generated. This hash is packed into the
13844 @code{#+RESULTS:} line and will be checked on subsequent
13845 executions of the code block. If the code block has not
13846 changed since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
13849 Code block caches notice if the value of a variable argument
13850 to the code block has changed. If this is the case, the cache is
13851 invalidated and the code block is re-run. In the following example,
13852 @code{caller} will not be re-run unless the results of @code{random} have
13853 changed since it was last run.
13857 #+BEGIN_SRC R :cache yes
13861 #+RESULTS[a2a72cd647ad44515fab62e144796432793d68e1]: random
13865 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=random :cache yes
13869 #+RESULTS[bec9c8724e397d5df3b696502df3ed7892fc4f5f]: caller
13873 @node sep, hlines, cache, Specific header arguments
13874 @subsubsection @code{:sep}
13876 The @code{:sep} header argument can be used to control the delimiter used
13877 when writing tabular results out to files external to Org mode. This is used
13878 either when opening tabular results of a code block by calling the
13879 @code{org-open-at-point} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-o} on the code block,
13880 or when writing code block results to an external file (see @ref{file})
13883 By default, when @code{:sep} is not specified output tables are tab
13886 @node hlines, colnames, sep, Specific header arguments
13887 @subsubsection @code{:hlines}
13889 Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
13890 hlines. The @code{:hlines} argument to a code block accepts the
13891 values @code{yes} or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
13895 Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most languages this is the
13896 desired effect because an @code{hline} symbol is interpreted as an unbound
13897 variable and raises an error. Setting @code{:hlines no} or relying on the
13898 default value yields the following results.
13901 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
13909 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols
13913 #+RESULTS: echo-table
13920 Leaves hlines in the table. Setting @code{:hlines yes} has this effect.
13923 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
13931 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
13935 #+RESULTS: echo-table
13944 @node colnames, rownames, hlines, Specific header arguments
13945 @subsubsection @code{:colnames}
13947 The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts the values @code{yes},
13948 @code{no}, or @code{nil} for unassigned. The default value is @code{nil}.
13949 Note that the behavior of the @code{:colnames} header argument may differ
13950 across languages. For example Emacs Lisp code blocks ignore the
13951 @code{:colnames} header argument entirely given the ease with which tables
13952 with column names may be handled directly in Emacs Lisp.
13956 If an input table looks like it has column names
13957 (because its second row is an hline), then the column
13958 names will be removed from the table before
13959 processing, then reapplied to the results.
13962 #+TBLNAME: less-cols
13968 #+NAME: echo-table-again
13969 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=less-cols
13970 return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
13973 #+RESULTS: echo-table-again
13980 Please note that column names are not removed before the table is indexed
13981 using variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
13984 No column name pre-processing takes place
13987 Column names are removed and reapplied as with @code{nil} even if the table
13988 does not ``look like'' it has column names (i.e.@: the second row is not an
13992 @node rownames, shebang, colnames, Specific header arguments
13993 @subsubsection @code{:rownames}
13995 The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on the values @code{yes}
13996 or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
14000 No row name pre-processing will take place.
14003 The first column of the table is removed from the table before processing,
14004 and is then reapplied to the results.
14007 #+TBLNAME: with-rownames
14008 | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
14009 | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
14011 #+NAME: echo-table-once-again
14012 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
14013 return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
14016 #+RESULTS: echo-table-once-again
14017 | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
14018 | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
14021 Please note that row names are not removed before the table is indexed using
14022 variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
14026 @node shebang, eval, rownames, Specific header arguments
14027 @subsubsection @code{:shebang}
14029 Setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value
14030 (e.g.@: @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}) causes the string to be inserted as the
14031 first line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
14032 permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
14034 @node eval, wrap, shebang, Specific header arguments
14035 @subsubsection @code{:eval}
14036 The @code{:eval} header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
14037 specific code blocks. The @code{:eval} header argument can be useful for
14038 protecting against the evaluation of dangerous code blocks or to ensure that
14039 evaluation will require a query regardless of the value of the
14040 @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable. The possible values of
14041 @code{:eval} and their effects are shown below.
14045 The code block will not be evaluated under any circumstances.
14047 Evaluation of the code block will require a query.
14048 @item never-export or no-export
14049 The code block will not be evaluated during export but may still be called
14052 Evaluation of the code block during export will require a query.
14055 If this header argument is not set then evaluation is determined by the value
14056 of the @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable see @ref{Code evaluation
14059 @node wrap, , eval, Specific header arguments
14060 @subsubsection @code{:wrap}
14061 The @code{:wrap} header argument is used to mark the results of source block
14062 evaluation. The header argument can be passed a string that will be appended
14063 to @code{#+BEGIN_} and @code{#+END_}, which will then be used to wrap the
14064 results. If not string is specified then the results will be wrapped in a
14065 @code{#+BEGIN/END_RESULTS} block.
14067 @node Results of evaluation, Noweb reference syntax, Header arguments, Working With Source Code
14068 @section Results of evaluation
14069 @cindex code block, results of evaluation
14070 @cindex source code, results of evaluation
14072 The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is invoked,
14073 as well as on whether @code{:results value} or @code{:results output} is
14074 used. The following table shows the table possibilities. For a full listing
14075 of the possible results header arguments see @ref{results}.
14077 @multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
14078 @item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
14079 @item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
14080 @item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
14083 Note: With @code{:results value}, the result in both @code{:session} and
14084 non-session is returned to Org mode as a table (a one- or two-dimensional
14085 vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
14087 @subsection Non-session
14088 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14089 This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the code
14090 in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating that
14091 function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body of such a
14092 function. In particular, note that Python does not automatically return a
14093 value from a function unless a @code{return} statement is present, and so a
14094 @samp{return} statement will usually be required in Python.
14096 This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the code is
14097 automatically wrapped in a function definition.
14099 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14100 The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
14101 contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
14102 languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area for
14105 @subsection Session
14106 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14107 The code is passed to an interpreter running as an interactive Emacs inferior
14108 process. Only languages which provide tools for interactive evaluation of
14109 code have session support, so some language (e.g., C and ditaa) do not
14110 support the @code{:session} header argument, and in other languages (e.g.,
14111 Python and Haskell) which have limitations on the code which may be entered
14112 into interactive sessions, those limitations apply to the code in code blocks
14113 using the @code{:session} header argument as well.
14115 Unless the @code{:results output} option is supplied (see below) the result
14116 returned is the result of the last evaluation performed by the
14117 interpreter. (This is obtained in a language-specific manner: the value of
14118 the variable @code{_} in Python and Ruby, and the value of @code{.Last.value}
14121 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14122 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
14123 inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the sequence of
14124 (text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that this is not
14125 necessarily the same as what would be sent to @code{STDOUT} if the same code
14126 were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as an external
14127 process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
14130 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output
14141 In non-session mode, the `2' is not printed and does not appear.
14143 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output :session
14155 But in @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives input `2'
14156 and prints out its value, `2'. (Indeed, the other print statements are
14159 @node Noweb reference syntax, Key bindings and useful functions, Results of evaluation, Working With Source Code
14160 @section Noweb reference syntax
14161 @cindex code block, noweb reference
14162 @cindex syntax, noweb
14163 @cindex source code, noweb reference
14165 The ``noweb'' (see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}) Literate
14166 Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by using the
14167 familiar Noweb syntax:
14170 <<code-block-name>>
14173 When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not ``noweb''
14174 references are expanded depends upon the value of the @code{:noweb} header
14175 argument. If @code{:noweb yes}, then a Noweb reference is expanded before
14176 evaluation. If @code{:noweb no}, the default, then the reference is not
14177 expanded before evaluation. See the @ref{noweb-ref} header argument for
14178 a more flexible way to resolve noweb references.
14180 It is possible to include the @emph{results} of a code block rather than the
14181 body. This is done by appending parenthesis to the code block name which may
14182 optionally contain arguments to the code block as shown below.
14185 <<code-block-name(optional arguments)>>
14188 Note: the default value, @code{:noweb no}, was chosen to ensure that
14189 correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where
14190 @code{<<arg>>} is a syntactically valid construct. If @code{<<arg>>} is not
14191 syntactically valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting
14194 Note: if noweb tangling is slow in large Org-mode files consider setting the
14195 @code{*org-babel-use-quick-and-dirty-noweb-expansion*} variable to true.
14196 This will result in faster noweb reference resolution at the expense of not
14197 correctly resolving inherited values of the @code{:noweb-ref} header
14200 @node Key bindings and useful functions, Batch execution, Noweb reference syntax, Working With Source Code
14201 @section Key bindings and useful functions
14202 @cindex code block, key bindings
14204 Many common Org mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
14207 Within a code block, the following key bindings
14210 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14212 @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-src-block}
14214 @item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14216 @item @kbd{C-@key{up}} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14218 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @code{org-babel-pop-to-session}
14221 In an Org mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
14223 @multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55
14225 @kindex C-c C-v C-p
14226 @item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-previous-src-block}
14228 @kindex C-c C-v C-n
14229 @item @kbd{C-c C-v n} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-n} @tab @code{org-babel-next-src-block}
14231 @kindex C-c C-v C-e
14232 @item @kbd{C-c C-v e} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-e} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-maybe}
14234 @kindex C-c C-v C-o
14235 @item @kbd{C-c C-v o} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14237 @kindex C-c C-v C-v
14238 @item @kbd{C-c C-v v} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-v} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14240 @kindex C-c C-v C-u
14241 @item @kbd{C-c C-v u} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-u} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-src-block-head}
14243 @kindex C-c C-v C-g
14244 @item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-g} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-src-block}
14246 @kindex C-c C-v C-r
14247 @item @kbd{C-c C-v r} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-r} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-result}
14249 @kindex C-c C-v C-b
14250 @item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14252 @kindex C-c C-v C-s
14253 @item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14255 @kindex C-c C-v C-d
14256 @item @kbd{C-c C-v d} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-d} @tab @code{org-babel-demarcate-block}
14258 @kindex C-c C-v C-t
14259 @item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14261 @kindex C-c C-v C-f
14262 @item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14264 @kindex C-c C-v C-c
14265 @item @kbd{C-c C-v c} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-check-src-block}
14267 @kindex C-c C-v C-j
14268 @item @kbd{C-c C-v j} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-j} @tab @code{org-babel-insert-header-arg}
14270 @kindex C-c C-v C-l
14271 @item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14273 @kindex C-c C-v C-i
14274 @item @kbd{C-c C-v i} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-i} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14276 @kindex C-c C-v C-I
14277 @item @kbd{C-c C-v I} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-I} @tab @code{org-babel-view-src-block-info}
14279 @kindex C-c C-v C-z
14280 @item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session-with-code}
14282 @kindex C-c C-v C-a
14283 @item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14285 @kindex C-c C-v C-h
14286 @item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-h} @tab @code{org-babel-describe-bindings}
14288 @kindex C-c C-v C-x
14289 @item @kbd{C-c C-v x} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-x} @tab @code{org-babel-do-key-sequence-in-edit-buffer}
14292 @c When possible these keybindings were extended to work when the control key is
14293 @c kept pressed, resulting in the following additional keybindings.
14295 @c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14296 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14297 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14298 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14299 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14300 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14301 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14302 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14303 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session}
14306 @node Batch execution, , Key bindings and useful functions, Working With Source Code
14307 @section Batch execution
14308 @cindex code block, batch execution
14309 @cindex source code, batch execution
14311 It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
14312 script calls @code{org-babel-tangle} on every one of its arguments.
14314 Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
14318 # -*- mode: shell-script -*-
14320 # tangle files with org-mode
14324 ORGINSTALL="~/src/org/lisp/org-install.el"
14326 # wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
14328 FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
14331 emacs -Q --batch -l $ORGINSTALL \
14333 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
14334 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\"))
14335 (require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
14336 (mapc (lambda (file)
14337 (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
14339 (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))" 2>&1 |grep tangled
14342 @node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Working With Source Code, Top
14343 @chapter Miscellaneous
14346 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
14347 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
14348 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
14349 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
14350 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
14351 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
14352 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
14353 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
14354 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
14355 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
14356 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
14360 @node Completion, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
14361 @section Completion
14362 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
14363 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
14364 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
14365 @cindex completion, of option keywords
14366 @cindex completion, of tags
14367 @cindex completion, of property keys
14368 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
14369 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
14370 @cindex TODO keywords completion
14371 @cindex dictionary word completion
14372 @cindex option keyword completion
14373 @cindex tag completion
14374 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
14376 Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org mode uses it whenever it
14377 makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
14378 some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
14379 most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
14380 @code{org-completion-use-ido}.
14382 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
14383 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
14384 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
14387 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
14389 Complete word at point
14392 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
14394 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
14396 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
14397 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
14399 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
14400 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
14401 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
14402 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
14404 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
14405 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
14408 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
14410 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
14411 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org mode. When the
14412 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
14413 will insert example settings for this keyword.
14415 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
14416 i.e.@: valid keys for this line.
14418 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
14422 @node Easy Templates, Speed keys, Completion, Miscellaneous
14423 @section Easy Templates
14424 @cindex template insertion
14425 @cindex insertion, of templates
14427 Org mode supports insertion of empty structural elements (like
14428 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} and @code{#+END_SRC} pairs) with just a few key
14429 strokes. This is achieved through a native template expansion mechanism.
14430 Note that Emacs has several other template mechanisms which could be used in
14431 a similar way, for example @file{yasnippet}.
14433 To insert a structural element, type a @samp{<}, followed by a template
14434 selector and @kbd{@key{TAB}}. Completion takes effect only when the above
14435 keystrokes are typed on a line by itself.
14437 The following template selectors are currently supported.
14439 @multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.9
14440 @item @kbd{s} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_SRC ... #+END_SRC}
14441 @item @kbd{e} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE ... #+END_EXAMPLE}
14442 @item @kbd{q} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_QUOTE ... #+END_QUOTE}
14443 @item @kbd{v} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_VERSE ... #+END_VERSE}
14444 @item @kbd{c} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_CENTER ... #+END_CENTER}
14445 @item @kbd{l} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_LaTeX ... #+END_LaTeX}
14446 @item @kbd{L} @tab @code{#+LaTeX:}
14447 @item @kbd{h} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_HTML ... #+END_HTML}
14448 @item @kbd{H} @tab @code{#+HTML:}
14449 @item @kbd{a} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_ASCII ... #+END_ASCII}
14450 @item @kbd{A} @tab @code{#+ASCII:}
14451 @item @kbd{i} @tab @code{#+INDEX:} line
14452 @item @kbd{I} @tab @code{#+INCLUDE:} line
14455 For example, on an empty line, typing "<e" and then pressing TAB, will expand
14456 into a complete EXAMPLE template.
14458 You can install additional templates by customizing the variable
14459 @code{org-structure-template-alist}. See the docstring of the variable for
14460 additional details.
14462 @node Speed keys, Code evaluation security, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous
14463 @section Speed keys
14465 @vindex org-use-speed-commands
14466 @vindex org-speed-commands-user
14468 Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
14469 beginning of a headline, i.e.@: before the first star. Configure the variable
14470 @code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
14471 pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
14472 variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
14473 navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
14474 execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a TTY,
14475 or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
14477 To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
14478 with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
14480 @node Code evaluation security, Customization, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
14481 @section Code evaluation and security issues
14483 Org provides tools to work with the code snippets, including evaluating them.
14485 Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk. Badly
14486 written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by accident. Org has
14487 default settings which will only evaluate such code if you give explicit
14488 permission to do so, and as a casual user of these features you should leave
14489 these precautions intact.
14491 For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation prompts can
14492 become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This can be done, but
14493 you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
14495 Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
14498 @item Source code blocks
14499 Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when pressing @kbd{C-c
14500 C-c} in the block. The most important thing to realize here is that Org mode
14501 files which contain code snippets are, in a certain sense, like executable
14502 files. So you should accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
14503 sources---just like you would do with a program you install on your computer.
14505 Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the variables
14506 which take off the default security brakes.
14508 @defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
14509 When t (the default), the user is asked before every code block evaluation.
14510 When nil, the user is not asked. When set to a function, it is called with
14511 two arguments (language and body of the code block) and should return t to
14512 ask and nil not to ask.
14515 For example, here is how to execute "ditaa" code (which is considered safe)
14518 (defun my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate (lang body)
14519 (not (string= lang "ditaa"))) ; don't ask for ditaa
14520 (setq org-confirm-babel-evaluate 'my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate)
14523 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
14524 Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
14525 links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated is
14528 @defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
14529 Function to queries user about shell link execution.
14531 @defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
14532 Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
14535 @item Formulas in tables
14536 Formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated
14537 either by the @i{calc} interpreter, or by the @i{Emacs Lisp} interpreter.
14540 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Code evaluation security, Miscellaneous
14541 @section Customization
14542 @cindex customization
14543 @cindex options, for customization
14544 @cindex variables, for customization
14546 There are more than 500 variables that can be used to customize
14547 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
14548 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
14549 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
14550 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
14551 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
14552 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
14554 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
14555 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
14556 @cindex in-buffer settings
14557 @cindex special keywords
14559 Org mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
14560 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
14561 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
14562 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
14563 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
14564 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
14565 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
14566 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
14567 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
14569 @vindex org-archive-location
14571 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
14572 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
14573 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
14574 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14575 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
14577 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
14578 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
14579 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14580 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
14581 @cindex property, COLUMNS
14582 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
14583 columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
14585 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
14586 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
14587 @vindex org-table-formula
14588 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
14589 line sets the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
14590 The global version of this variable is
14591 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
14592 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
14593 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
14595 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
14596 @vindex org-drawers
14597 Set the file-local set of additional drawers. The corresponding global
14598 variable is @code{org-drawers}.
14599 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
14600 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
14601 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
14602 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
14603 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
14604 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
14605 @vindex org-highest-priority
14606 @vindex org-lowest-priority
14607 @vindex org-default-priority
14608 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
14609 must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must
14610 have a lower ASCII number than the lowest priority.
14611 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
14612 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
14613 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
14614 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
14615 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
14616 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
14617 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
14618 (i.e.@: when starting Org mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
14619 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
14620 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
14621 any other Org mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
14622 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
14625 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org mode, when an
14626 Org file is being visited.
14628 The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
14629 tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
14630 @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
14632 @vindex org-startup-folded
14633 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
14634 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
14635 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
14636 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
14638 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
14639 content @r{all headlines}
14640 showall @r{no folding of any entries}
14641 showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
14644 @vindex org-startup-indented
14645 @cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
14646 @cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
14647 Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
14648 @code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org mode 6.29 are required}
14650 indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
14651 noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
14654 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
14655 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
14656 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
14657 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
14659 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
14660 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
14662 align @r{align all tables}
14663 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
14666 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
14667 When visiting a file, inline images can be automatically displayed. The
14668 corresponding variable is @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}, with a
14669 default value @code{nil} to avoid delays when visiting a file.
14670 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14671 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14673 inlineimages @r{show inline images}
14674 noinlineimages @r{don't show inline images on startup}
14677 @vindex org-log-done
14678 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
14679 @vindex org-log-repeat
14680 Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
14681 configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
14682 @code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
14683 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
14684 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
14685 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
14686 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
14687 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
14688 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14689 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14690 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14691 @cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14692 @cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14693 @cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14694 @cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14695 @cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14696 @cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14697 @cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
14698 @cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
14699 @cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
14701 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
14702 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
14703 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
14704 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
14705 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
14706 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
14707 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
14708 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
14709 logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
14710 lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
14711 nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
14712 logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
14713 lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
14714 nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
14715 logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
14716 lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
14717 nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
14719 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
14720 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
14721 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
14722 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
14723 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
14724 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
14725 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
14726 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
14727 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
14728 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
14730 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
14731 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
14732 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
14733 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
14734 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
14735 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
14737 @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
14738 @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
14739 To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
14740 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
14741 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
14742 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
14744 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
14746 @vindex constants-unit-system
14747 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
14748 @code{constants-unit-system}).
14749 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
14750 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
14752 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
14753 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
14755 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
14756 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
14757 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
14758 To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
14759 corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
14760 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
14761 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
14762 @cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
14763 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
14764 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
14765 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
14766 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
14767 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
14768 @cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
14769 @cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
14771 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
14772 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
14773 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
14774 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
14775 fnauto @r{create @code{[fn:1]}-like labels automatically (default)}
14776 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
14777 fnplain @r{create @code{[1]}-like labels automatically}
14778 fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
14779 nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
14781 @cindex org-hide-block-startup
14782 To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
14783 @code{org-hide-block-startup}.
14784 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
14785 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
14787 hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
14788 nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
14790 @cindex org-pretty-entities
14791 The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the variable
14792 @code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
14793 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
14794 @cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
14796 entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible}
14797 entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
14799 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
14800 @vindex org-tag-alist
14801 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
14802 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
14803 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
14805 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
14806 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
14807 @itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:, #+XSLT:,
14808 @itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,
14809 @itemx #+LaTeX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
14810 @itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
14811 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
14812 @ref{Export options}.
14813 @item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
14814 @vindex org-todo-keywords
14815 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
14816 current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
14819 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
14820 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
14822 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
14824 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
14825 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
14826 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
14827 other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
14828 here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
14829 what this means in different contexts.
14833 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
14834 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
14836 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
14837 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
14840 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
14841 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
14843 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
14846 If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it.
14847 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
14850 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
14851 corresponding links in this buffer.
14853 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
14854 drawer, offer property commands.
14856 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
14857 definition, and vice versa.
14859 If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
14861 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
14864 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
14867 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
14870 If the cursor is at a timestamp, fix the day name in the timestamp.
14873 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
14874 @section A cleaner outline view
14875 @cindex hiding leading stars
14876 @cindex dynamic indentation
14877 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
14878 @cindex clean outline view
14880 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
14881 potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
14882 indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
14883 where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
14884 @emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
14888 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
14889 ** Second level | * Second level
14890 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
14891 some text | some text
14892 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
14893 more text | more text
14894 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
14900 If you are using at least Emacs 23.2@footnote{Emacs 23.1 can actually crash
14901 with @code{org-indent-mode}} and version 6.29 of Org, this kind of view can
14902 be achieved dynamically at display time using @code{org-indent-mode}. In
14903 this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for display with the necessary amount
14904 of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode} also sets the @code{wrap-prefix}
14905 property, such that @code{visual-line-mode} (or purely setting
14906 @code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
14907 }. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of
14908 indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
14909 @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
14910 stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
14911 face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
14912 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
14913 @code{nil}.} - see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
14914 works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
14915 the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
14916 individual files using
14922 If you want a similar effect in an earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
14923 you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
14924 file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
14929 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
14930 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
14931 with the headline, like
14935 more text, now indented
14938 @vindex org-adapt-indentation
14939 Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
14940 editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
14941 preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
14944 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
14945 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
14946 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
14947 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
14951 #+STARTUP: hidestars
14952 #+STARTUP: showstars
14955 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
14959 * Top level headline
14967 @vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
14968 The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
14969 fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
14970 font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
14971 have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
14972 to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
14973 example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
14976 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
14977 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
14978 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
14979 to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
14980 or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc@.}. In this
14981 way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
14982 to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
14983 correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
14984 a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
14991 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
14992 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
14993 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
14994 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
14997 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
14998 @section Using Org on a tty
14999 @cindex tty key bindings
15001 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
15002 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
15003 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
15004 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
15005 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
15006 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
15007 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
15008 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
15009 customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
15010 is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
15011 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
15013 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
15014 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
15015 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
15016 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
15017 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
15018 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
15019 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
15020 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
15021 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
15022 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
15023 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
15024 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15025 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
15026 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15027 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15028 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15029 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15030 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15031 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15032 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15036 @node Interaction, org-crypt.el, TTY keys, Miscellaneous
15037 @section Interaction with other packages
15038 @cindex packages, interaction with other
15039 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
15040 with other code out there.
15043 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
15044 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
15047 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
15048 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
15051 @cindex @file{calc.el}
15052 @cindex Gillespie, Dave
15053 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
15054 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
15055 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
15056 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
15057 @code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
15058 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
15059 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
15060 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
15061 , Embedded Mode, calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
15062 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
15063 @cindex @file{constants.el}
15064 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
15065 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
15066 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
15067 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
15068 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
15069 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
15070 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
15071 @samp{Mega}, etc@. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
15072 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
15073 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
15074 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
15075 @file{constants.el}.
15076 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
15077 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
15078 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
15079 Org mode can make use of the CD@LaTeX{} package to efficiently enter
15080 @LaTeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
15081 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
15082 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
15083 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org mode
15084 supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
15086 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15087 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
15089 @vindex org-imenu-depth
15090 By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
15091 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
15092 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
15093 @cindex @file{remember.el}
15094 @cindex Wiegley, John
15095 Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
15096 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
15097 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
15098 @cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
15099 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
15100 index items in files. Org mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
15101 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
15102 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
15103 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
15104 @cindex @file{table.el}
15105 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
15107 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
15108 @cindex @file{table.el}
15109 @cindex Ota, Takaaki
15111 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
15112 and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota
15113 (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, and also part of Emacs 22).
15114 Org mode will recognize these tables and export them properly. Because of
15115 interference with other Org mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit
15116 these tables directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command
15117 @kbd{C-c '} to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
15120 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-edit-special}
15121 Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
15123 @orgcmd{C-c ~,org-table-create-with-table.el}
15124 Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
15125 command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org mode
15126 format. See the documentation string of the command
15127 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
15130 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
15131 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
15132 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
15133 @cindex Baur, Steven L.
15134 Org mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
15135 However, Org mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
15136 which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
15139 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
15140 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org mode
15144 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
15145 @vindex org-support-shift-select
15146 In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
15147 cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
15148 This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
15149 timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
15150 at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
15151 special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
15152 @code{org-support-shift-select}. Org mode then tries to accommodate shift
15153 selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
15154 commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
15155 cursor moves across a special context.
15157 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
15158 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
15159 @cindex Storm, Kim. F.
15160 @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
15161 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
15162 (as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
15163 region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
15164 @code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
15165 23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
15166 if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
15167 Org mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
15168 Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
15169 buffer (but not during date selection).
15172 S-UP @result{} M-p S-DOWN @result{} M-n
15173 S-LEFT @result{} M-- S-RIGHT @result{} M-+
15174 C-S-LEFT @result{} M-S-- C-S-RIGHT @result{} M-S-+
15177 @vindex org-disputed-keys
15178 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
15179 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
15180 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
15182 @item @file{yasnippet.el}
15183 @cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
15184 The way Org mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
15185 @code{"\t"}) overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The following code
15186 fixed this problem:
15189 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15191 (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
15192 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-or-maybe-expand)))
15195 The latest version of yasnippet doesn't play well with Org mode. If the
15196 above code does not fix the conflict, start by defining the following
15200 (defun yas/org-very-safe-expand ()
15201 (let ((yas/fallback-behavior 'return-nil)) (yas/expand)))
15204 Then, tell Org mode what to do with the new function:
15207 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15209 (make-variable-buffer-local 'yas/trigger-key)
15210 (setq yas/trigger-key [tab])
15211 (add-to-list 'org-tab-first-hook 'yas/org-very-safe-expand)
15212 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field)))
15215 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
15216 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
15217 This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
15218 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
15219 the windmove function active in locations where Org mode does not have
15220 special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
15224 ;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
15225 (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
15226 (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
15227 (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
15228 (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
15231 @item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
15232 @cindex @file{viper.el}
15234 Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
15235 corresponding Org mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
15236 another key for this command, or override the key in
15237 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
15240 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
15245 @node org-crypt.el, , Interaction, Miscellaneous
15246 @section org-crypt.el
15247 @cindex @file{org-crypt.el}
15248 @cindex @code{org-decrypt-entry}
15250 Org-crypt will encrypt the text of an entry, but not the headline, or
15251 properties. Org-crypt uses the Emacs EasyPG library to encrypt and decrypt
15254 Any text below a headline that has a @samp{:crypt:} tag will be automatically
15255 be encrypted when the file is saved. If you want to use a different tag just
15256 customize the @code{org-crypt-tag-matcher} setting.
15258 To use org-crypt it is suggested that you have the following in your
15262 (require 'org-crypt)
15263 (org-crypt-use-before-save-magic)
15264 (setq org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance (quote ("crypt")))
15266 (setq org-crypt-key nil)
15267 ;; GPG key to use for encryption
15268 ;; Either the Key ID or set to nil to use symmetric encryption.
15270 (setq auto-save-default nil)
15271 ;; Auto-saving does not cooperate with org-crypt.el: so you need
15272 ;; to turn it off if you plan to use org-crypt.el quite often.
15273 ;; Otherwise, you'll get an (annoying) message each time you
15276 ;; To turn it off only locally, you can insert this:
15278 ;; # -*- buffer-auto-save-file-name: nil; -*-
15281 Excluding the crypt tag from inheritance prevents already encrypted text
15282 being encrypted again.
15284 @node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
15288 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
15292 * Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
15293 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
15294 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
15295 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
15296 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
15297 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
15298 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
15299 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
15300 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
15301 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
15304 @node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
15308 Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
15309 functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
15310 use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
15311 maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
15312 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
15314 @node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
15315 @section Add-on packages
15316 @cindex add-on packages
15318 A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
15319 These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
15320 packages with the separate release available at the Org mode home page at
15321 @uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
15322 documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
15323 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
15327 @node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
15328 @section Adding hyperlink types
15329 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
15331 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
15332 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
15333 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
15334 @file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
15335 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
15339 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
15343 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
15344 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
15346 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
15347 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
15349 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
15351 (defun org-man-open (path)
15352 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
15353 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
15354 (funcall org-man-command path))
15356 (defun org-man-store-link ()
15357 "Store a link to a manpage."
15358 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
15359 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
15360 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
15361 (link (concat "man:" page))
15362 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
15363 (org-store-link-props
15366 :description description))))
15368 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
15369 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
15370 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
15371 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
15372 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
15373 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
15377 ;;; org-man.el ends here
15381 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
15388 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
15391 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
15394 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
15395 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
15396 that will be called to follow such a link.
15398 @vindex org-store-link-functions
15399 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
15400 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
15401 buffer displaying a man page.
15404 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
15405 First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
15406 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
15407 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
15408 defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
15409 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
15410 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
15412 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
15413 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
15414 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
15415 create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
15416 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
15417 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
15418 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
15419 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
15420 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
15421 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
15422 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
15423 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
15425 When it makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
15426 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g.@: completion)
15427 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
15428 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
15430 @node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
15431 @section Context-sensitive commands
15432 @cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
15433 @cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
15434 @vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
15436 Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
15437 important example is the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
15438 Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
15440 Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
15441 special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
15442 the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
15443 allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language
15444 @footnote{@file{org-R.el} has been replaced by the Org mode functionality
15445 described in @ref{Working With Source Code} and is now obsolete.}. For this
15446 package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
15450 (defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
15451 "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
15452 (if (save-excursion
15453 (beginning-of-line 1)
15454 (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
15455 (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
15456 t) ;; to signal that we took action
15457 nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
15459 (add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
15462 The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
15463 case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
15464 signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
15465 contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns
15466 @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
15469 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
15470 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
15471 @cindex tables, in other modes
15472 @cindex lists, in other modes
15473 @cindex Orgtbl mode
15475 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
15476 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
15477 specific languages, for example @LaTeX{}. However, this is extremely
15478 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
15479 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl mode table
15482 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
15483 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
15484 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
15485 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
15486 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
15487 for a very flexible system.
15489 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct mode. You
15490 can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by turning
15491 @code{orgstruct-mode} on, then locally exporting such lists in another format
15492 (HTML, @LaTeX{} or Texinfo.)
15496 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
15497 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
15498 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
15499 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
15502 @node Radio tables, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15503 @subsection Radio tables
15504 @cindex radio tables
15506 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
15507 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
15508 Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
15509 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
15512 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15513 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15517 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
15518 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
15522 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
15526 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
15527 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
15528 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
15529 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
15530 passed as a property list to the translation function for
15531 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
15532 acted upon before the translation function is called:
15536 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
15539 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
15540 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
15541 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
15542 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
15543 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
15544 additional columns.
15548 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
15549 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
15550 compilation of a C file or processing of a @LaTeX{} file. There are a
15551 number of different solutions:
15555 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
15556 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
15557 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
15559 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
15560 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
15563 You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
15564 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
15565 only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
15566 makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
15570 @node A @LaTeX{} example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15571 @subsection A @LaTeX{} example of radio tables
15572 @cindex @LaTeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
15574 The best way to wrap the source table in @LaTeX{} is to use the
15575 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
15576 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
15577 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
15578 default this works only for @LaTeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
15579 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
15580 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
15581 be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
15582 will then get the following template:
15584 @cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
15586 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15587 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15589 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15595 @vindex @LaTeX{}-verbatim-environments
15596 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
15597 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into @LaTeX{} and to put it
15598 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
15599 fill in the table---feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
15600 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
15601 this may cause problems with font-lock in @LaTeX{} mode. As shown in the
15602 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
15603 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
15604 expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
15605 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
15606 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
15609 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15610 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15612 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15613 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
15614 |-------+------+---------+---------|
15615 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
15616 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
15617 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
15618 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
15619 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
15624 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
15625 table inserted between the two marker lines.
15627 Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
15628 want to control how columns are aligned, etc@. In this case we make sure
15629 that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
15630 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e.@: to not produce
15631 header and footer commands of the target table:
15634 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
15635 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
15636 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15637 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15641 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
15642 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
15643 |-------+------+---------+---------|
15644 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
15645 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
15646 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
15647 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
15651 The @LaTeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
15652 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
15653 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
15654 interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
15657 @item :splice nil/t
15658 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
15659 tabular environment. Default is nil.
15662 A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
15663 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
15664 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
15665 column numbers and formats, for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
15666 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
15667 function must return a formatted string.
15670 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
15671 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
15672 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
15673 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
15674 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
15675 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
15676 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
15677 supplied instead of strings.
15680 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15681 @subsection Translator functions
15682 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
15683 @cindex translator function
15685 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
15686 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
15687 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
15688 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
15689 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
15690 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
15691 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
15692 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
15693 hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
15697 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
15698 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
15699 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
15700 org-table-last-alignment ""))
15703 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
15704 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
15705 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
15706 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
15707 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
15711 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
15712 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
15713 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e.@: the
15714 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
15715 would like to use the @LaTeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
15716 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
15717 overrule the default with
15720 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
15723 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
15724 analogy with the @LaTeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
15725 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
15726 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
15727 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
15728 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
15732 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
15733 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
15737 Please check the documentation string of the function
15738 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
15739 that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
15740 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
15741 using the generic function.
15743 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
15744 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
15745 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
15746 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
15747 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
15748 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
15749 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
15750 translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
15751 others can benefit from your work.
15753 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15754 @subsection Radio lists
15755 @cindex radio lists
15756 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
15758 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way as sending and
15759 receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
15760 insert radio list templates in HTML, @LaTeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
15761 @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
15763 Here are the differences with radio tables:
15767 Orgstruct mode must be active.
15769 Use the @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
15771 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
15774 @kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
15777 Here is a @LaTeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
15782 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
15783 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
15785 #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
15794 Pressing `C-c C-c' on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
15795 @LaTeX{} list between the two marker lines.
15797 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
15798 @section Dynamic blocks
15799 @cindex dynamic blocks
15801 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
15802 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
15803 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
15804 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
15806 Dynamic blocks are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
15807 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
15808 the content of the block.
15810 @cindex #+BEGIN:dynamic block
15812 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
15817 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
15820 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
15821 Update dynamic block at point.
15822 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
15823 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
15826 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
15827 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
15828 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
15829 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
15830 extra parameter @code{:content}.
15832 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
15833 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
15834 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
15835 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
15839 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
15845 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
15848 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
15849 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
15850 (insert "Last block update at: "
15851 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
15854 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
15855 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
15856 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
15857 written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
15860 You can narrow the current buffer to the current dynamic block (like any
15861 other block) with @code{org-narrow-to-block}.
15863 @node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
15864 @section Special agenda views
15865 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
15867 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
15868 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function-global
15869 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the selection
15870 made by these agenda views: @code{agenda}, @code{todo}, @code{alltodo},
15871 @code{tags}, @code{tags-todo}, @code{tags-tree}. You may specify a function
15872 that is used at each match to verify if the match should indeed be part of
15873 the agenda view, and if not, how much should be skipped. You can specify a
15874 global condition that will be applied to all agenda views, this condition
15875 would be stored in the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-function-global}. More
15876 commonly, such a definition is applied only to specific custom searches,
15877 using @code{org-agenda-skip-function}.
15879 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
15880 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
15881 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
15882 PROJECT. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
15883 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
15884 the subtree belonging to the project line.
15886 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
15887 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
15888 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
15889 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
15890 search should continue from there.
15893 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
15894 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
15895 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
15896 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
15897 nil ; tag found, do not skip
15898 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
15901 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
15905 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
15906 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
15907 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
15908 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
15911 @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
15912 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
15913 meaningful header in the agenda view.
15915 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
15916 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
15917 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
15918 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
15919 your custom search function, simply do a search for
15920 @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
15921 level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
15922 stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
15923 you really want to have.
15925 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
15926 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
15927 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
15930 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
15931 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
15932 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
15933 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
15934 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
15935 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
15936 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
15937 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
15938 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
15939 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
15940 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
15941 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
15942 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
15943 Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
15944 @anchor{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp}
15945 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'regexp "regular expression")
15946 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
15947 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notregexp "regular expression")
15948 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
15949 @item (org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
15950 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
15953 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
15954 like this, even without defining a special function:
15957 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
15958 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
15959 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
15960 'regexp ":waiting:"))
15961 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
15964 @node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
15965 @section Extracting agenda information
15966 @cindex agenda, pipe
15967 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
15969 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
15970 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
15971 line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
15972 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
15973 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
15974 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
15975 ASCII text to STDOUT. The command takes a single string as parameter.
15976 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
15977 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
15978 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
15979 current TODO list, you could use
15982 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
15985 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
15986 tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
15987 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
15988 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
15991 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
15992 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
15996 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
15999 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
16000 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
16001 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
16002 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
16003 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
16008 which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
16009 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
16011 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
16012 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
16013 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
16014 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
16018 category @r{The category of the item}
16019 head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
16020 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
16021 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
16022 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
16023 diary @r{imported from diary}
16024 deadline @r{a deadline}
16025 scheduled @r{scheduled}
16026 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
16027 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
16028 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
16029 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
16030 block @r{entry has date block including date}
16031 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
16032 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
16033 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
16034 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
16035 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
16036 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
16037 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
16041 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
16042 led to the selection of the item.
16044 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
16045 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
16046 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
16051 # define the Emacs command to run
16052 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
16054 # run it and capture the output
16055 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
16057 # loop over all lines
16058 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
16059 # get the individual values
16060 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
16061 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
16062 # process and print
16063 print "[ ] $head\n";
16067 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
16068 @section Using the property API
16069 @cindex API, for properties
16070 @cindex properties, API
16072 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
16075 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
16076 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
16077 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
16078 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
16079 entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may occur multiple times
16080 if the property key was used several times.@*
16081 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
16082 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
16083 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
16085 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
16086 @findex org-insert-property-drawer
16087 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
16088 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM. By default,
16089 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
16090 is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
16091 higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
16092 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
16093 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
16096 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
16097 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
16100 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
16101 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
16104 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
16105 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
16108 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
16109 Insert a property drawer for the current entry. Also
16112 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
16113 Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES. VALUES should be a list of
16114 strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
16117 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
16118 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16119 values and return the values as a list of strings.
16122 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
16123 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16124 values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
16127 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
16128 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16129 values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
16132 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
16133 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16134 values and check if VALUE is in this list.
16137 @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
16138 Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific property.
16139 The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
16140 return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
16141 the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
16142 to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
16143 responsible for this property.
16146 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
16147 @section Using the mapping API
16148 @cindex API, for mapping
16149 @cindex mapping entries, API
16151 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
16152 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
16153 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
16154 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
16157 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
16158 Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
16160 FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
16161 arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
16162 The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
16163 returned as a list.
16165 The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
16166 does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
16167 moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
16168 processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
16169 circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
16170 if you have removed (e.g.@: archived) the current (sub)tree it could
16171 mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
16172 can specify the position from where search should continue by making
16173 FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
16176 MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
16177 Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
16178 the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
16179 visited by the iteration.
16181 SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
16184 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
16185 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
16186 region @r{The entries within the active region, if any}
16187 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
16189 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
16190 agenda @r{all agenda files}
16191 agenda-with-archives
16192 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
16194 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
16197 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
16198 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
16200 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16202 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
16203 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
16204 function or Lisp form
16205 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
16206 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
16207 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
16208 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
16212 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
16213 It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
16214 information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
16215 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
16217 @defun org-todo &optional arg
16218 Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the functions for
16219 the many possible values for the argument ARG.
16222 @defun org-priority &optional action
16223 Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this function for the
16224 possible values for ACTION.
16227 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
16228 Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
16229 or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
16233 Promote the current entry.
16237 Demote the current entry.
16240 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
16241 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
16242 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
16246 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
16247 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
16250 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
16251 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
16254 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
16257 @node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
16258 @appendix MobileOrg
16262 @i{MobileOrg} is the name of the mobile companion app for Org mode, currently
16263 available for iOS and for Android. @i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing and
16264 capture support for an Org mode system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It
16265 does also allow you to record changes to existing entries.
16266 The @uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/, iOS implementation} for the
16267 @i{iPhone/iPod Touch/iPad} series of devices, was developed by Richard
16268 Moreland. Android users should check out
16269 @uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg Android}
16270 by Matt Jones. The two implementations are not identical but offer similar
16273 This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
16274 format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
16275 captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
16277 For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
16278 customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
16279 cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files use only
16280 part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
16281 in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of TODO state
16282 @i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
16283 (@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
16286 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
16287 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
16288 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
16291 @node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16292 @section Setting up the staging area
16294 MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through a directory on a server. If you
16295 are using a public server, you should consider to encrypt the files that are
16296 uploaded to the server. This can be done with Org mode 7.02 and with
16297 @i{MobileOrg 1.5} (iPhone version), and you need an @file{openssl}
16298 installation on your system. To turn on encryption, set a password in
16299 @i{MobileOrg} and, on the Emacs side, configure the variable
16300 @code{org-mobile-use-encryption}@footnote{If you can safely store the
16301 password in your Emacs setup, you might also want to configure
16302 @code{org-mobile-encryption-password}. Please read the docstring of that
16303 variable. Note that encryption will apply only to the contents of the
16304 @file{.org} files. The file names themselves will remain visible.}.
16306 The easiest way to create that directory is to use a free
16307 @uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com} account@footnote{If you cannot use
16308 Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg does not support it, you can use a
16309 webdav server. For more information, check out the documentation of MobileOrg and also this
16310 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.html#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
16311 When MobileOrg first connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory
16312 @i{MobileOrg} inside the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell
16316 (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
16319 Org mode has commands to put files for @i{MobileOrg} into that directory,
16320 and to read captured notes from there.
16322 @node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
16323 @section Pushing to MobileOrg
16325 This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
16326 to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
16327 all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
16328 can be included by customizing @code{org-mobile-files}. File names will be
16329 staged with paths relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
16330 inside this directory. The push operation also creates a special Org file
16331 @file{agendas.org} with all custom agenda view defined by the
16332 user@footnote{While creating the agendas, Org mode will force ID properties
16333 on all referenced entries, so that these entries can be uniquely identified
16334 if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for further action. If you do not want to get
16335 these properties in so many entries, you can set the variable
16336 @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items} to @code{nil}. Org mode will then
16337 rely on outline paths, in the hope that these will be unique enough.}.
16338 Finally, Org writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to all other
16339 files. @i{MobileOrg} first reads this file from the server, and then
16340 downloads all agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the download,
16341 MobileOrg will only read files whose checksums@footnote{stored automatically
16342 in the file @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
16344 @node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16345 @section Pulling from MobileOrg
16347 When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
16348 files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to flagged
16349 and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org has
16350 a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an inbox file
16351 and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it works:
16355 Org moves all entries found in
16356 @file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
16357 operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
16358 @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
16359 will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
16361 After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
16362 @i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
16363 interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
16364 text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
16365 action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
16366 again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
16367 pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
16368 message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
16370 Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
16371 should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
16372 If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
16373 will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
16378 Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
16379 another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
16380 z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
16381 Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
16382 @code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
16383 in a property). In this way you indicate that the intended processing for
16384 this flagged entry is finished.
16389 If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
16390 return to this agenda view@footnote{Note, however, that there is a subtle
16391 difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x org-mobile-pull
16392 @key{RET}} is guaranteed to search all files that have been addressed by the
16393 last pull. This might include a file that is not currently in your list of
16394 agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate the view, only
16395 the current agenda files will be searched.} using @kbd{C-c a ?}.
16397 @node History and Acknowledgments, Main Index, MobileOrg, Top
16398 @appendix History and acknowledgments
16399 @cindex acknowledgments
16403 Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
16404 Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
16405 Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
16406 different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
16407 parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also,
16408 when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the
16409 tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility
16410 cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the
16411 package @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
16412 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning,
16413 the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and
16414 @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org
16415 still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
16416 and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
16417 functionality directly into a notes file.
16419 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
16420 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
16421 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
16422 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
16423 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
16424 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
16425 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
16428 Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
16431 @item Bastien Guerry
16432 Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
16433 integrated into the core by now), including the @LaTeX{} exporter and the plain
16434 list parser. His support during the early days, when he basically acted as
16435 co-maintainer, was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
16436 invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsored
16437 hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
16438 @item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
16439 Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
16440 Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
16441 programming and reproducible research.
16443 John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly to Org,
16444 including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}), integration with
16445 Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical dependencies of TODO
16446 items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and encryption
16447 (@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an extended copy
16448 of his great @file{remember.el}.
16449 @item Sebastian Rose
16450 Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
16451 of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
16452 higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
16453 webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
16454 single-key navigation.
16457 @noindent OK, now to the full list of contributions! Again, please let me
16458 know what I am missing here!
16463 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
16465 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
16467 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
16470 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
16472 @i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
16474 @i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org mode files.
16476 @i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
16478 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
16479 for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
16481 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
16484 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
16485 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
16486 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
16488 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
16490 @i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
16492 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
16493 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
16496 @i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
16498 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
16499 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
16500 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
16502 @i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
16503 the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
16505 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format, inspired
16506 the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and wrote
16507 @file{org-taskjuggler.el}.
16509 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
16512 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
16514 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
16516 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
16517 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
16519 @i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
16521 @i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
16523 @i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
16525 @i{Eric Fraga} drove the development of BEAMER export with ideas and
16528 @i{Barry Gidden} did proofreading the manual in preparation for the book
16529 publication through Network Theory Ltd.
16531 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
16533 @i{Nicolas Goaziou} rewrote much of the plain list code.
16535 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
16537 @i{Brian Gough} of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as a
16540 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
16541 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
16542 been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
16544 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
16547 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
16549 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
16550 folded entries, and column view for properties.
16552 @i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
16554 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
16556 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded @LaTeX{} and tested it. He also
16557 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
16559 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
16560 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
16562 @i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
16563 and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
16564 small fixes and patches.
16566 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
16568 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
16570 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
16573 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
16576 @i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
16578 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
16579 and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
16581 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
16583 @i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
16585 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
16586 file links, and TAGS.
16588 @i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a Perl program to create a text
16589 version of the reference card.
16591 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
16594 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
16596 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
16597 links, among other things.
16599 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
16600 provided frequent feedback.
16602 @i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
16603 into bundles of 20 for undo.
16605 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
16607 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
16610 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
16611 also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
16613 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
16615 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
16616 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
16618 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
16621 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
16622 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
16624 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
16627 @i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
16629 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
16630 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
16632 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
16633 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
16635 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
16636 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
16638 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
16641 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
16643 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
16644 tweaks and features.
16646 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
16647 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
16649 @i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
16650 @LaTeX{}, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
16652 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
16653 with links transformation to Org syntax.
16655 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
16656 chapter about publishing.
16658 @i{Jambunathan K} contributed the ODT exporter.
16660 @i{Sebastien Vauban} reported many issues with @LaTeX{} and BEAMER export and
16661 enabled source code highlighting in Gnus.
16663 @i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
16664 Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
16665 concept index for HTML export.
16667 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
16670 @i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
16672 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
16675 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
16678 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
16681 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
16684 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
16685 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
16690 @node Main Index, Key Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
16691 @unnumbered Concept index
16695 @node Key Index, Command and Function Index, Main Index, Top
16696 @unnumbered Key index
16700 @node Command and Function Index, Variable Index, Key Index, Top
16701 @unnumbered Command and function index
16705 @node Variable Index, , Command and Function Index, Top
16706 @unnumbered Variable index
16708 This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
16709 mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
16710 org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
16716 @c Local variables:
16718 @c indent-tabs-mode: nil
16719 @c paragraph-start: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|\f\\|[ ]*$"
16720 @c paragraph-separate: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|[ \f]*$"
16724 @c LocalWords: webdavhost pre